Conditional Signaling of Video Coding Syntax Elements

ABSTRACT

Systems, methods and apparatus for video processing are described. The video processing may include video encoding, video decoding, or video transcoding. One example method of video processing includes performing a conversion between a video including one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule. The format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates whether motion vector difference for a particular reference picture list (RPL) is indicated is conditionally included in the bitstream based on (i) whether a second syntax element indicating whether an RPL information is included in a picture header and/or (ii) a number of reference pictures in the particular RPL in case that the RPL information is present in the picture header.

CROSS REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS

This application is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 17/973,810, filed on Oct. 26, 2022, which is a continuation of International Patent Application No. PCT/US2021/028974 filed on Apr. 23, 2021, which claims the priority to and benefits of U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 63/015,623 filed on Apr. 26, 2020. All the aforementioned patent applications are hereby incorporated by reference in their entireties.

TECHNICAL FIELD

The present disclosure relates to image and video coding and decoding.

BACKGROUND

Digital video accounts for the largest bandwidth use on the internet and other digital communication networks. As the number of connected user devices capable of receiving and displaying video increases, it is expected that the bandwidth demand for digital video usage will continue to grow.

SUMMARY

The present disclosure discloses techniques that can be used by video encoders and decoders for processing coded representation of video using control information useful for decoding of the coded representation.

In one example aspect, a video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video having one or more chroma components, the video comprising one or more video pictures comprising one or more slices and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a chroma array type field controls a constraint on a conversion characteristic of chroma used during the conversion.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures comprising one or more video regions and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule that specifies the include a deblocking mode indicator for a video region indicative of applicability of a deblocking filter to the video region during the conversion.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures comprising one or more video slices and/or one or more video subpictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule that specifies that a flag indicating whether a single slice per subpicture mode is deemed to be enabled for a video picture in case that a picture partitioning is disabled for the video picture.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures comprising one or more video slices and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule that specifies that a picture or a slice level chroma quantization parameter offset is signaled in a picture header or a slice header.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes: performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures comprising one or more video slices and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule that specifies that a chroma quantization parameter (QP) table applicable for conversion of a video block of the video is derived as an XOR operation between (delta_qp_in_val_minus1[i][j]+1) and delta_qp_diff_val[i][j], wherein delta_qp_in_val_minus1[i][j] specifies a delta value used to derive the input coordinate of the j-th pivot point of the i-th chroma mapping table and delta_qp_diff_val[i][j] specifies a delta value used to derive the output coordinate of the j-th pivot point of the i-th chroma QP mapping table, where i and j are integers.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a first Syntax Element (SE) that indicates whether to signal Motion Vector Difference (MVD) for a reference picture list (RPL) is conditionally included in the coded representation based on whether a second SE indicating whether a reference picture list information is signaled in a picture header and a number of reference pictures in the RPL when the RPL information is present in picture header.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a first Syntax Element (SE) that indicates whether to disable a decoder motion vector refinement (DMVR) tool is conditionally included in the coded representation based on whether a second SE indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in a Picture Header (PH), and a number of reference pictures in a previous RPL when the RPL information is present in PH, and/or whether a flag indicative of applicability of the DMVR tool included at a sequence parameter set level in the coded representation is equal to 1.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a first Syntax Element (SE) that indicates whether to disable a bi-directional optical flow (BDOF) tool is conditionally included in the coded representation based on whether a second SE indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in a Picture Header (PH), and a number of reference pictures in RPL-1 when the RPL information is present in PH, and/or a flag indicative of applicability of the BDOF tool at a sequence parameter set level.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a first Syntax Element (SE) that indicates whether the collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference picture list 0 is conditionally included based on a second SE indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in a Picture Header (PH), and a number of reference pictures in RPL-1 when the RPL information is present in PH, and whether a temporal motion vector prediction (TMVP) tool is enabled for coding a current picture.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that whether a first syntax element (SE) indicating a table of prediction weights is included in the coded representation is conditionally based on a second SE indicating whether weighted prediction (WP) information is signalled in a picture header (PH), and whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in the PH, and a number of reference pictures in RPL-1 when the RPL information is present in the PH, and whether flags indicative of applicability of weighted prediction and/or weighted bi-prediction are included in a picture parameter set.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that whether use of intra slices is allowed for representing a video picture in the coded representation depends on whether inter slices are allowed for the picture and whether there are more than one partitions.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates whether motion vector difference for a particular reference picture list (RPL) is indicated is conditionally included in the bitstream based on (i) whether a second syntax element indicating whether an RPL information is included in a picture header and/or (ii) a number of reference pictures in the particular RPL in case that the RPL information is present in the picture header.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a rule, and wherein the rule specifies which syntax elements in a general constraint information syntax structure that indicates one or more constraints applicable to the conversion are grouped together.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that an indication that use of intra slices within a picture is enabled for a picture is selectively included based on (i) whether an inter slice is allowed in the picture and/or (ii) whether the picture is partitioned into more than one partitions.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates whether a decoder motion vector refinement (DMVR) tool is disabled is conditionally included in the bitstream based on (i) whether a second syntax element indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is included in a picture header (PH), and/or (ii) a number of reference pictures in a RPL in case that the RPL information is present in the PH, and/or (iii) whether a flag indicative of applicability of the DMVR tool included at a sequence parameter set level in the bitstream is equal to a certain value.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates whether to disable a bi-directional optical flow (BDOF) tool is conditionally included in the bitstream based on (i) whether a second syntax element indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is included in a picture header (PH), and/or (ii) a number of reference pictures in a RPL in case that the RPL information is present in the PH, and/or (iii) a flag indicative of applicability of the BDOF tool at a sequence parameter set level.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates whether a collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference picture list 0 is conditionally included based on (i) a second syntax element indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in a picture header (PH), and/or (ii) a number of reference pictures in a RPL in case that the RPL information is present in the PH, and/or (iii) a flag indicative of an applicability of a temporal motion vector prediction (TMVP) tool for coding a current picture.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies whether a first syntax element indicating a table of prediction weights is conditionally included in the bitstream based on (i) a second syntax element indicating whether weighted prediction (WP) information is included in a picture header (PH), and/or (ii) a third syntax element indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is included in the PH, and/or (iii) a number of reference pictures in a RPL in case that the RPL information is present in the PH, and/or (iv) a fourth syntax element indicating an applicability of weighted prediction and/or a fifth syntax element indicating an applicability of weighted bi-prediction that is included in a picture parameter set.

In another example aspect, another video processing method is disclosed. The method includes performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates a number of weights signalled for entries in a particular reference picture list is conditionally included in a syntax structure indicating a table of prediction weight parameters of the bitstream based on (i) a second syntax element indicating whether weighted prediction (WP) information is included in a picture header and/or (ii) a third syntax element indicating whether reference picture list (RPL) information is included in the picture header, and/or (iii) a number of reference pictures in the particular RPL, and/or (iv) a fourth syntax element included in a picture parameter set and indicating an applicability of explicit weighted prediction to B slices referring to the picture parameter set.

In yet another example aspect, a video encoder apparatus is disclosed. The video encoder comprises a processor configured to implement above-described methods.

In yet another example aspect, a video decoder apparatus is disclosed. The video decoder comprises a processor configured to implement above-described methods.

In yet another example aspect, a computer readable medium having code stored thereon is disclose. The code embodies one of the methods described herein in the form of processor-executable code.

These, and other, features are described throughout the present disclosure.

BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF DRAWINGS

FIG. 1 is a block diagram of an example video processing system.

FIG. 2 is a block diagram of a video processing apparatus.

FIG. 3 is a flowchart for an example method of video processing.

FIG. 4 is a block diagram that illustrates a video coding system in accordance with some embodiments of the present disclosure.

FIG. 5 is a block diagram that illustrates an encoder in accordance with some embodiments of the present disclosure.

FIG. 6 is a block diagram that illustrates a decoder in accordance with some embodiments of the present disclosure.

FIG. 7 is a flowchart for an example method of video processing.

FIGS. 8A to 8G are flowchart for example methods of video processing.

FIG. 9 is a flowchart for an example method of video processing.

DETAILED DESCRIPTION

Section headings are used in the present disclosure for ease of understanding and do not limit the applicability of techniques and embodiments disclosed in each section only to that section. Furthermore, H.266 terminology is used in some description only for ease of understanding and not for limiting scope of the disclosed techniques. As such, the techniques described herein are applicable to other video codec protocols and designs also.

1. INTRODUCTION

This document is related to video coding technologies. Specifically, it is about the syntax design of APS, deblocking, subpicture, and QP delta in video coding. The ideas may be applied individually or in various combination, to any video coding standard or non-standard video codec that supports multi-layer video coding, e.g., the being-developed Versatile Video Coding (VVC).

2. ABBREVIATIONS

-   -   ALF Adaptive Loop Filter     -   APS Adaptation Parameter Set     -   AU Access Unit     -   AUD Access Unit Delimiter     -   AVC Advanced Video Coding     -   CB/Cb Blue Difference Chroma     -   CCALF Cross-Component ALF     -   CR/Cr Red Difference Chroma     -   CLVS Coded Layer Video Sequence     -   CPB Coded Picture Buffer     -   CRA Clean Random Access     -   CTB Coding Tree Block     -   CTU Coding Tree Unit     -   CU Coding Unit     -   CVS Coded Video Sequence     -   DPB Decoded Picture Buffer     -   DPS Decoding Parameter Set     -   EG Exponential-Golomb     -   EOB End Of Bitstream     -   EOS End Of Sequence     -   GDR Gradual Decoding Refresh     -   HEVC High Efficiency Video Coding     -   HRD Hypothetical Reference Decoder     -   ID Identifier     -   IDR Instantaneous Decoding Refresh     -   IRAP Intra Random Access Point     -   JEM Joint Exploration Model     -   LFNST Low Frequency Non-Separable Transform     -   LMCS Luma Mapping With Chroma Scaling     -   LSB Least Significant Bits     -   MCTS Motion-Constrained Tile Sets     -   MSB Most Significant Bits     -   NAL Network Abstraction Layer     -   NUT NAL Unit Type     -   OLS Output Layer Set     -   PH Picture Header     -   PPS Picture Parameter Set     -   PROF Prediction Refinement with Optical Flow     -   PTL Profile, Tier and Level     -   PU Picture Unit     -   RADL Random Access Decodable Leading (Picture)     -   RASL Random Access Skipped Leading (Picture)     -   RBSP Raw Byte Sequence Payload     -   SAO Sample Adaptive Offset     -   SEI Supplemental Enhancement Information     -   SH Slice Header     -   SPS Sequence Parameter Set     -   SVC Scalable Video Coding     -   VCL Video Coding Layer     -   VPS Video Parameter Set     -   VTM VVC Test Model     -   VUI Video Usability Information     -   VVC Versatile Video Coding     -   Y Luminance

3. INITIAL DISCUSSION

Video coding standards have evolved primarily through the development of the well-known International Telecommunication Union-Telecommunication Standardization Sector (ITU-T) and International Organization for Standardization (ISO)/International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) standards. The ITU-T produced H.261 and H.263, ISO/IEC produced Moving Picture Experts Group (MPEG)-1 and MPEG-4 Visual, and the two organizations jointly produced the H.262/MPEG-2 Video and H.264/MPEG-4 Advanced Video Coding (AVC) and H.265/HEVC standards. Since H.262, the video coding standards are based on the hybrid video coding structure wherein temporal prediction plus transform coding are utilized. To explore the future video coding technologies beyond HEVC, the Joint Video Exploration Team (JVET) was founded by Video Coding Experts Group (VCEG) and MPEG jointly in 2015. Since then, many new methods have been adopted by JVET and put into the reference software named Joint Exploration Model (JEM). The JVET meeting is concurrently held once every quarter, and the new coding standard is targeting at 50% bitrate reduction as compared to HEVC. The new video coding standard was officially named as Versatile Video Coding (VVC) in the April 2018 JVET meeting, and the first version of VVC test model (VTM) was released at that time. As there are continuous effort contributing to VVC standardization, new coding techniques are being adopted to the VVC standard in every JVET meeting. The VVC working draft and test model VTM are then updated after every meeting. The VVC project is now aiming for technical completion (FDIS) at the July 2020 meeting.

3.1. PPS Syntax and Semantics

In the latest VVC draft text, the PPS syntax and semantics are as follows:

Descriptor pic_parameter_set_rbsp( ) {  pps_pic_parameter_set_id ue(v)  pps_seq_parameter_set_id u(4)  mixed_nalu_types_in_pic_flag u(1)  pic_width_in_luma_samples ue(v)  pic_height_in_luma_samples ue(v)  pps_conformance_window_flag u(1)  if( pps_conformance_window_flag) {   pps_conf_win_left_offset ue(v)   pps_conf_win_right_offset ue(v)   pps_conf_win_top_offset ue(v)   pps_conf_win_bottom_offset ue(v)  }  scaling_window_explicit_signalling_flag u(1)  if( scaling_window_explicit_signalling_flag ) {   scaling_win_left_offset ue(v)   scaling_win_right_offset ue(v)   scaling_win_top_offset ue(v)   scaling_win_bottom_offset ue(v)  }  output_flag_present_flag u(1)  subpic_id_mapping_in_pps_flag u(1)  if( subpic_id_mapping_in_pps_flag ) {   pps_num_subpics_minus1 ue(v)   pps_subpic_id_len_minus1 ue(v)   for( i = 0; i <= pps_num_subpic_minus1; i++ )    pps_subpic_id[ i ] u(v)  }  no_pic_partition_flag u(1)  if( !no_pic_partition_flag) {   pps_log2_ctu_size_minus5 u(2)   num_exp_tile_columns_minus1 ue(v)   num_exp_tile_rows_minus1 ue(v)   for( i = 0; i <= num_exp_tile_columns_minus1; i++)    tile_column_width_minus1[ i ] ue(v)   for( i = 0; i <= num_exp_tile_rows_minus1; i++ )    tile_row_height_minus1[ i ] ue(v)   if( NumTilesInPic > 1 )    rect_slice_flag u(1)   if( rect_slice_flag )    single_slice_per_subpic_flag u(1)   if( rect_slice_flag && !single_slice_per_subpic_flag) {    num_slices_in_pic_minus1 ue(v)    if( num_slices_in_pic_minus1 > 0 )     tile_idx_delta_present_flag u(1)    for( i = 0; i < num_slices_in_pic_minus1; i++) {     if( NumTileColumns > 1)      slice_width_in_tiles_minus1[ i ] ue(v)     if( NumTileRows > 1 &&       ( tile_idx_delta_present_flag ∥ tileIdx % NumTileColumns = = 0 ))      slice_height_in_tiles_minus1[ i ] ue(v)     if( slice_width_in_tiles_minus1[ i ] = = 0 &&       slice_height_in_tiles_minus1[ i ] = = 0 &&  RowHeight[ SliceTopLeftTileIdx[ i ] /  NumTileColumns ] > 1 ) {      num_exp_slices_in_tile[ i ] ue(v)      for( j = 0; j < num_exp_slices_in_tile[ i ]; j++)       exp_slice_height_in_ctus_minus1 [ j ] ue(v)      i += NumSlicesInTile[ i ] − 1     }     if( tile_idx_delta_present flag && i < num_slices_in_pic_minus1 )      tile_idx_delta[ i ] se(v)    }   }   loop_filter_across_tiles_enabled_flag u(1)   loop_filter_across_slices_enabled_flag u(1)  }  cabac_init_present_flag u(1)  for( i = 0; i < 2; i++)   num_ref_idx_default_active_minus1[ i ] ue(v)  rpl1_idx_present_flag u(1)  init_qp_minus26 se(v)  cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag u(1)  pps_chroma_tool_offsets_present_flag u(1)  if( pps_chroma_tool_offsets_present_flag) {   pps_cb_qp_offset se(v)   pps_cr_qp_offset se(v)   pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_present_flag u(1)   if( pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_present_flag )    pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_value se(v)   pps_slice_chroma_qp_offsets_present_flag u(1)   pps_cu_chroma_qp_offset_list_enabled_flag u(1)  }  if( pps_cu_chroma_qp_offset_list_enabled_flag) {   chroma_qp_offset_list_len_minus1 ue(v)   for( i = 0; i <=   chroma_qp_offset_list_len_minus1; i++ ) {    cb_qp_offset_list[ i ] se(v)    cr_qp_offset_list[ i ] se(v)    if( pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_present_flag)     joint_cbcr_qp_offset_list[ i ] se(v)   }  }  pps_weighted_pred_flag u(1)  pps_weighted_bipred_flag u(1)  deblocking_filter_control_present_flag u(1)  if( deblocking_filter_control_present flag) {   deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag u(1)   pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag u(1)   if( !pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag ) {    pps_beta_offset_div2 se(v)    pps_tc_offset_div2 se(v)    pps_cb_beta_offset_div2 se(v)    pps_cb_tc_offset_div2 se(v)    pps_cr_beta_offset_div2 se(v)    pps_cr_tc_offset_div2 se(v)   }  }  rpl_info_in_ph_flag u(1)  if( deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag )   dbf_info_in_ph_flag u(1)  sao_info_in_ph_flag u(1)  alf_info_in_ph_flag u(1)  if( (pps_weighted_pred_flag ∥ pps_weighted_bipred_flag) && rpl_info_in_ph_flag )   wp_info_in_ph_flag u(1)  qp_delta_info_in_ph_flag u(1)  pps_ref_wraparound_enabled_flag u(1)  if( pps_ref_wraparound_enabled_flag )   pps_ref_wraparound_offset ue(v)  picture_header_extension_present_flag u(1)  slice_header_extension_present_flag u(1)  pps_extension_flag u(1)  if( pps_extension_flag)   while( more_rbsp_data( ) )    pps_extension_data_flag u(1)  rbsp_trailing_bits( ) }

A PPS RBSP shall be available to the decoding process prior to it being referenced, included in at least one AU with TemporalId less than or equal to the TemporalId of the PPS NAL unit or provided through external means.

All PPS NAL units with a particular value of pps_pic_parameter_set_id within a PU shall have the same content.

pps_pic_parameter_set_id identifies the PPS for reference by other syntax elements. The value of pps_pic_parameter_set_id shall be in the range of 0 to 63, inclusive.

PPS NAL units, regardless of the nuh_layer_id values, share the same value space of pps_pic_parameter_set_id.

Let ppsLayerId be the value of the nuh_layer_id of a particular PPS NAL unit, and vclLayerId be the value of the nuh_layer_id of a particular VCL NAL unit. The particular VCL NAL unit shall not refer to the particular PPS NAL unit unless ppsLayerId is less than or equal to vclLayerId and the layer with nuh_layer_id equal to ppsLayerId is included in at least one OLS that includes the layer with nuh_layer_id equal to vclLayerId.

pps_seq_parameter_set_id specifies the value of sps_seq_parameter_set_id for the SPS. The value of pps_seq_parameter_set_id shall be in the range of 0 to 15, inclusive. The value of pps_seq_parameter_set_id shall be the same in all PPSs that are referred to by coded pictures in a CLVS.

mixed_nalu_types_in_pic_flag equal to 1 specifies that each picture referring to the PPS has more than one VCL NAL unit, the VCL NAL units do not have the same value of nal_unit_type, and the picture is not an IRAP picture.

mixed_nalu_types_in_pic_flag equal to 0 specifies that each picture referring to the PPS has one or more VCL NAL units and the VCL NAL units of each picture referring to the PPS have the same value of nal_unit_type.

When no_mixed_nalu_types_in_pic_constraint_flag is equal to 1, the value of mixed_nalu_types_in_pic_flag shall be equal to 0.

For each slice with a nal_unit_type value nalUnitTypeA in the range of IDR_W_RADL to CRA_NUT, inclusive, in a picture picA that also contains one or more slices with another value of nal_unit_type (i.e., the value of mixed_nalu_types_in_pic_flag for the picture picA is equal to 1), the following applies:

-   -   The slice shall belong to a subpicture subpicA for which the         value of the corresponding subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is         equal to 1.     -   The slice shall not belong to a subpicture of picA containing         VCL NAL units with nal_unit_type not equal to nalUnitTypeA.     -   If nalUnitTypeA is equal to CRA, for all the following PUs         following the current picture in the CLVS in decoding order and         in output order, neither RefPicList[0] nor RefPicList[1] of a         slice in subpicA in those PUs shall include any picture         preceding picA in decoding order in an active entry.     -   Otherwise (i.e., nalUnitTypeA is equal to IDR_W_RADL or         IDR_N_LP), for all the PUs in the CLVS following the current         picture in decoding order, neither RefPicList[0] nor         RefPicList[1] of a slice in subpicA in those PUs shall include         any picture preceding picA in decoding order in an active entry.         -   NOTE 1—mixed_nalu_types_in_pic_flag equal to 1 indicates             that pictures referring to the PPS contain slices with             different NAL unit types, e.g., coded pictures originating             from a subpicture bitstream merging operation for which             encoders have to ensure matching bitstream structure and             further alignment of parameters of the original bitstreams.             One example of such alignments is as follows: When the value             of sps_idr_rpl_flag is equal to 0 and             mixed_nalu_types_in_pic_flag is equal to 1, a picture             referring to the PPS cannot have slices with nal_unit_type             equal to IDR_W_RADL or IDR_N_LP.

pic_width_in_luma_samples specifies the width of each decoded picture referring to the PPS in units of luma samples. pic_width_in_luma_samples shall not be equal to 0, shall be an integer multiple of Max(8, MinCbSizeY), and shall be less than or equal to pic_width_max_in_luma_samples.

When res_change_in_clvs_allowed_flag equal to 0, the value of pic_width_in_luma_samples shall be equal to pic_width_max_in_luma_samples.

pic_height_in_luma_samples specifies the height of each decoded picture referring to the PPS in units of luma samples. pic_height_in_luma_samples shall not be equal to 0 and shall be an integer multiple of Max(8, MinCbSizeY), and shall be less than or equal to pic_height_max_in_luma_samples.

When res_change_in_clvs_allowed_flag equal to 0, the value of pic_height_in_luma_samples shall be equal to pic_height_max_in_luma_samples.

The variables PicWidthInCtbsY, PicHeightInCtbsY, PicSizeInCtbsY, PicWidthInMinCbsY, PicHeightInMinCbsY, PicSizeInMinCbsY, PicSizeInSamplesY, PicWidthInSamplesC and PicHeightInSamplesC are derived as follows:

PicWidthInCtbsY=Ceil(pic_width_in_luma_samples÷CtbSizeY)  (69)

PicHeightInCtbsY=Ceil(pic_height_in_luma_samples÷CtbSizeY)  (70)

PicSizeInCtbsY=PicWidthInCtbsY*PicHeightInCtbsY  (71)

PicWidthInMinCbsY=pic_width_in_luma_samples/MinCbSizeY  (72)

PicHeightInMinCbsY=pic_height_in_luma_samples/MinCbSizeY  (73)

PicSizeInMinCbsY=PicWidthInMinCbsY*PicHeightInMinCbsY  (74)

PicSizeInSamplesY=pic_width_in_luma_samples*pic_height_in_luma_samples  (75)

PicWidthInSamplesC=pic_width_in_luma_samples/SubWidthC  (76)

PicHeightInSamplesC=pic_height_in_luma_samples/SubHeightC  (77)

pps_conformance_window_flag equal to 1 indicates that the conformance cropping window offset parameters follow next in the PPS. pps_conformance_window_flag equal to 0 indicates that the conformance cropping window offset parameters are not present in the PPS.

pps_conf_win_left_offset, pps_conf_win_right_offset, pps_conf_win_top_offset, and pps_conf_win_bottom_offset specify the samples of the pictures in the CLVS that are output from the decoding process, in terms of a rectangular region specified in picture coordinates for output. When pps_conformance_window_flag is equal to 0, the values of pps_conf_win_left_offset, pps_conf_win_right_offset, pps_conf_win_top_offset, and pps_conf_win_bottom_offset are inferred to be equal to 0.

The conformance cropping window contains the luma samples with horizontal picture coordinates from SubWidthC*pps_conf_win_left_offset to pic_width_in_luma_samples−(SubWidthC*pps_conf_win_right_offset+1) and vertical picture coordinates from SubHeightC*pps_conf_win_top_offset to pic_height_in_luma_samples−(SubHeightC*pps_conf_win_bottom_offset+1), inclusive.

The value of SubWidthC*(pps_conf_win_left_offset+pps_conf_win_right_offset) shall be less than pic_width_in_luma_samples, and the value of SubHeightC*(pps_conf_win_top_offset+pps_conf_win_bottom_offset) shall be less than pic_height_in_luma_samples.

When ChromaArrayType is not equal to 0, the corresponding specified samples of the two chroma arrays are the samples having picture coordinates (x/SubWidthC, y/SubHeightC), where (x, y) are the picture coordinates of the specified luma samples.

-   -   NOTE 2—The conformance cropping window offset parameters are         only applied at the output. All internal decoding processes are         applied to the uncropped picture size.

Let ppsA and ppsB be any two PPSs referring to the same SPS. It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that, when ppsA and ppsB have the same the values of pic_width_in_luma_samples and pic_height_in_luma_samples, respectively, ppsA and ppsB shall have the same values of pps_conf_win_left_offset, pps_conf_win_right_offset, pps_conf_win_top_offset, and pps_conf_win_bottom_offset, respectively.

When pic_width_in_luma_samples is equal to pic_width_max_in_luma_samples and pic_height_in_luma_samples is equal to pic_height_max_in_luma_samples, it is a requirement of bitstream conformance that pps_conf_win_left_offset, pps_conf_win_right_offset, pps_conf_win_top_offset, and pps_conf_win_bottom_offset, are equal to sps_conf_win_left_offset, sps_conf_win_right_offset, sps_conf_win_top_offset, and sps_conf_win_bottom_offset, respectively.

scaling_window_explicit_signalling_flag equal to 1 specifies that the scaling window offset parameters are present in the PPS. scaling_window_explicit_signalling_flag equal to 0 specifies that the scaling window offset parameters are not present in the PPS. When res_change_in_clvs_allowed_flag is equal to 0, the value of scaling_window_explicit_signalling_flag shall be equal to 0.

scaling_win_left_offset, scaling_win_right_offset, scaling_win_top_offset, and scaling_win_bottom_offset specify the offsets that are applied to the picture size for scaling ratio calculation. When not present, the values of scaling_win_left_offset, scaling_win_right_offset, scaling_win_top_offset, and scaling_win_bottom_offset are inferred to be equal to pps_conf_win_left_offset, pps_conf_win_right_offset, pps_conf_win_top_offset, and pps_conf_win_bottom_offset, respectively.

The value of SubWidthC*(scaling_win_left_offset+scaling_win_right_offset) shall be less than pic_width_in_luma_samples, and the value of

SubHeightC*(scaling_win_top_offset+scaling_win_bottom_offset) shall be less than pic_height_in_luma_samples.

The variables PicOutputWidthL and PicOutputHeightL are derived as follows:

PicOutputWidthL=pic_width_in_luma_samples−SubWidthC*(scaling_win_right_offset+scaling_win_left_offset)  (78)

PicOutputHeightL=pic_height_in_luma_samples−SubWidthC*(scaling_win_bottom_offset+scaling_win_top_offset)  (79)

Let refPicOutputWidthL and refPicOutputHeightL be the PicOutputWidthL and PicOutputHeightL, respectively, of a reference picture of a current picture referring to this PPS. Is a requirement of bitstream conformance that all of the following conditions are satisfied:

-   -   PicOutputWidthL*2 shall be greater than or equal to         refPicWidthInLumaSamples.     -   PicOutputHeightL*2 shall be greater than or equal to         refPicHeightInLumaSamples.     -   PicOutputWidthL shall be less than or equal to         refPicWidthInLumaSamples*8.     -   PicOutputHeightL shall be less than or equal to         refPicHeightInLumaSamples*8.     -   PicOutputWidthL*pic_width_max_in_luma_samples shall be greater         than or equal to         refPicOutputWidthL*(pic_width_in_luma_samples−Max(8,         MinCbSizeY)).     -   PicOutputHeightL*pic_height_max_in_luma_samples shall be greater         than or equal to         refPicOutputHeightL*(pic_height_in_luma_samples−Max(8,         MinCbSizeY)).

output_flag_present_flag equal to 1 indicates that the pic_output_flag syntax element is present in slice headers referring to the PPS. output_flag_present_flag equal to 0 indicates that the pic_output_flag syntax element is not present in slice headers referring to the PPS.

subpic_id_mapping_in_pps_flag equal to 1 specifies that the subpicture ID mapping is signalled in the PPS. subpic_id_mapping_in_pps_flag equal to 0 specifies that the subpicture ID mapping is not signalled in the PPS. If subpic_id_mapping_explicitly_signalled_flag is 0 or subpic_id_mapping_in_sps_flag is equal to 1, the value of subpic_id_mapping_in_pps_flag shall be equal to 0. Otherwise (subpic_id_mapping_explicitly_signalled_flag is equal to 1 and subpic_id_mapping_in_sps_flag is equal to 0), the value of subpic_id_mapping_in_pps_flag shall be equal to 1.

pps_num_subpics_minus1 shall be equal to sps_num_subpics_minus1

pps_subpic_id_len_minus1 shall be equal to sps_subpic_id_len_minus1.

pps_subpic_id[i] specifies the subpicture ID of the i-th subpicture. The length of the pps_subpic_id[i] syntax element is pps_subpic_id_len_minus1+1 bits.

The variable SubpicIdVal[i], for each value of i in the range of 0 to sps_num_subpics_minus1, inclusive, is derived as follows:

for( i = 0; i <= sps_num_subpics_minus1; i++ )  if( subpic_id_mapping_explicitly_signalled_flag )   SubpicIdVal[ i ] = subpic_id_mapping_in_pps flag ?   pps_subpic_id[ i ] : sps_subpic_id[ i ]  (80)  else   SubpicIdVal[ i ] = i

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that both of the following constraints apply:

-   -   For any two different values of i and j in the range of 0 to         sps_num_subpics_minus1, inclusive, SubpicIdVal[i] shall not be         equal to SubpicIdVal[j].     -   When the current picture is not the first picture of the CLVS,         for each value of i in the range of 0 to sps_num_subpics_minus1,         inclusive, if the value of SubpicIdVal[i] is not equal to the         value of SubpicIdVal[i] of the previous picture in decoding         order in the same layer, the nal_unit_type for all coded slice         NAL units of the subpicture in the current picture with         subpicture index i shall be equal to a particular value in the         range of IDR_W_RADL to CRA_NUT, inclusive.

no_pic_partition_flag equal to 1 specifies that no picture partitioning is applied to each picture referring to the PPS. no_pic_partition_flag equal to 0 specifies each picture referring to the PPS may be partitioned into more than one tile or slice.

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the value of no_pic_partition_flag shall be the same for all PPSs that are referred to by coded pictures within a CLVS.

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the value of no_pic_partition_flag shall not be equal to 1 when the value of sps_num_subpics_minus1+1 is greater than 1.

pps_log 2_ctu_size_minus5 plus 5 specifies the luma coding tree block size of each CTU. pps_log 2_ctu_size_minus5 shall be equal to sps_log 2_ctu_size_minus5.

num_exp_tile_columns_minus1 plus 1 specifies the number of explicitly provided tile column widths. The value of num_exp_tile_columns_minus1 shall be in the range of 0 to PicWidthInCtbsY−1, inclusive. When no_pic_partition_flag is equal to 1, the value of num_exp_tile_columns_minus1 is inferred to be equal to 0.

num_exp_tile_rows_minus1 plus 1 specifies the number of explicitly provided tile row heights. The value of num_exp_tile_rows_minus1 shall be in the range of 0 to PicHeightInCtbsY−1, inclusive. When no_pic_partition_flag is equal to 1, the value of num_tile_rows_minus1 is inferred to be equal to 0.

tile_column_width_minus1[i] plus 1 specifies the width of the i-th tile column in units of CTBs for i in the range of 0 to num_exp_tile_columns_minus1−1, inclusive. tile_column_width_minus1[num_exp_tile_columns_minus1] is used to derive the width of the tile columns with index greater than or equal to num_exp_tile_columns_minus1 as specified in clause 6.5.1. The value of tile_column_width_minus1[i] shall be in the range of 0 to PicWidthInCtbsY−1, inclusive. When not present, the value of tile_column_width_minus1[0] is inferred to be equal to PicWidthInCtbsY−1.

tile_row_height_minus1[i] plus 1 specifies the height of the i-th tile row in units of CTBs for i in the range of 0 to num_exp_tile_rows_minus1−1, inclusive. tile_row_height_minus1[num_exp_tile_rows_minus1] is used to derive the height of the tile rows with index greater than or equal to num_exp_tile_rows_minus1 as specified in clause 6.5.1.

The value of tile_row_height_minus1[i] shall be in the range of 0 to PicHeightInCtbsY−1, inclusive. When not present, the value of tile_row_height_minus1[0] is inferred to be equal to PicHeightInCtbsY−1.

rect_slice_flag equal to 0 specifies that tiles within each slice are in raster scan order and the slice information is not signalled in PPS. rect_slice_flag equal to 1 specifies that tiles within each slice cover a rectangular region of the picture and the slice information is signalled in the PPS. When not present, rect_slice_flag is inferred to be equal to 1. When subpic_info_present_flag is equal to 1, the value of rect_slice_flag shall be equal to 1.

single_slice_per_subpic_flag equal to 1 specifies that each subpicture consists of one and only one rectangular slice. single_slice_per_subpic_flag equal to 0 specifies that each subpicture may consist of one or more rectangular slices.

When single_slice_per_subpic_flag is equal to 1, num_slices_in_pic_minus1 is inferred to be equal to sps_num_subpics_minus1. When not present, the value of single_slice_per_subpic_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

num_slices_in_pic_minus1 plus 1 specifies the number of rectangular slices in each picture referring to the PPS. The value of num_slices_in_pic_minus1 shall be in the range of 0 to MaxSlicesPerPicture−1, inclusive, where MaxSlicesPerPicture is specified in Annex A. When no_pic_partition_flag is equal to 1, the value of num_slices_in_pic_minus1 is inferred to be equal to 0.

tile_idx_delta_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that tile_idx_delta values are not present in the PPS and all rectangular slices in pictures referring to the PPS are specified in raster order according to the process defined in clause 6.5.1. tile_idx_delta_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that tile_idx_delta values may be present in the PPS and all rectangular slices in pictures referring to the PPS are specified in the order indicated by the values of tile_idx_delta.

When not present, the value of tile_idx_delta_present_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

slice_width_in_tiles_minus1[i] plus 1 specifies the width of the i-th rectangular slice in units of tile columns. The value of slice_width_in_tiles_minus1[i] shall be in the range of 0 to NumTileColumns−1, inclusive.

When slice_width_in_tiles_minus1[i] is not present, the following applies:

-   -   If NumTileColumns is equal to 1, the value of         slice_width_in_tiles_minus1[i] is inferred to be equal to 0.     -   Otherwise, the value of slice_width_in_tiles_minus1[i] is         inferred as specified in clause 6.5.1.

slice_height_in_tiles_minus1[i] plus 1 specifies the height of the i-th rectangular slice in units of tile rows. The value of slice_height_in_tiles_minus1[i] shall be in the range of 0 to NumTileRows−1, inclusive.

When slice_height_in_tiles_minus1[i] is not present, the following applies:

-   -   If NumTileRows is equal to 1, or tile_idx_delta_present_flag is         equal to 0 and tileIdx % NumTileColumns is greater than 0), the         value of slice_height_in_tiles_minus1[i] is inferred to be equal         to 0.     -   Otherwise (NumTileRows is not equal to 1, and         tile_idx_delta_present_flag is equal to 1 or tileIdx %         NumTileColumns is equal to 0), when tile_idx_delta_present_flag         is equal to 1 or tileIdx % NumTileColumns is equal to 0, the         value of slice_height_in_tiles_minus1[i] is inferred to be equal         to slice_height_in_tiles_minus1[i−1].

num_exp_slices_in_tile[i] specifies the number of explicitly provided slice heights in the current tile that contains more than one rectangular slices. The value of num_exp_slices_in_tile[i] shall be in the range of 0 to RowHeight[tileY]−1, inclusive, where tileY is the tile row index containing the i-th slice. When not present, the value of num_exp_slices_in_tile[i] is inferred to be equal to 0. When num_exp_slices_in_tile[i] is equal to 0, the value of the variable NumSlicesInTile[i] is derived to be equal to 1.

exp_slice_height_in_ctus_minus1[j] plus 1 specifies the height of the j-th rectangular slice in the current tile in units of CTU rows. The value of exp_slice_height_in_ctus_minus1[j] shall be in the range of 0 to RowHeight[tileY]−1, inclusive, where tileY is the tile row index of the current tile.

When num_exp_slices_in_tile[i] is greater than 0, the variable NumSlicesInTile[i] and SliceHeightInCtusMinus1[i+k] for k in the range of 0 to NumSlicesInTile[i]−1 are derived as follows:

remainingHeightlnCtbsY = RowHeight[ SliceTopLeftTileIdx[ i ] / NumTileColumns ] numExpSliceInTile = num_exp_slices_in_tile[ i ] for( j = 0; j < numExpSlicelnTile − 1; j++ ) {  SliceHeightInCtusMinus1[ i++ ] = exp_slice_height_in_ctu_minus1[ j ]  remainingHeightlnCtbsY −= SliceHeightInCtusMinus1[ j ] } uniformSliceHeightMinus1 = SliceHeightInCtusMinus1[ i − 1 ] (81) while( remainingHeightlnCtbsY >= (uniformSliceHeightMinus1 + 1)) {  SliceHeightInCtusMinus1[ i++ ] = uniformSliceHeightMinus1  remainingHeightInCtbsY −= (uniformSliceHeightMinusl + 1)  j++ } if( remainingHeightInCtbsY > 0 ) {  SliceHeightInCtusMinus1 i++ ] = remainingHeightInCtbsY  j++ } NumSlicesInTile[ i ] = j

tile_idx_delta[i] specifies the difference between the tile index of the first tile in the i-th rectangular slice and the tile index of the first tile in the (i+1)-th rectangular slice. The value of tile_idx_delta[i] shall be in the range of −NumTilesInPic+1 to NumTilesInPic−1, inclusive. When not present, the value of tile_idx_delta[i] is inferred to be equal to 0. When present, the value of tile_idx_delta[i] shall not be equal to 0.

loop_filter_across_tiles_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that in-loop filtering operations may be performed across tile boundaries in pictures referring to the PPS. loop_filter_across_tiles_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that in-loop filtering operations are not performed across tile boundaries in pictures referring to the PPS. The in-loop filtering operations include the deblocking filter, sample adaptive offset filter, and adaptive loop filter operations. When not present, the value of loop_filter_across_tiles_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 1.

loop_filter_across_slices_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that in-loop filtering operations may be performed across slice boundaries in pictures referring to the PPS. loop_filter_across_slice_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that in-loop filtering operations are not performed across slice boundaries in pictures referring to the PPS. The in-loop filtering operations include the deblocking filter, sample adaptive offset filter, and adaptive loop filter operations. When not present, the value of loop_filter_across_slices_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

cabac_init_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that cabac_init_flag is present in slice headers referring to the PPS. cabac_init_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that cabac_init_flag is not present in slice headers referring to the PPS.

num_ref_idx_default_active_minus1[i] plus 1, when i is equal to 0, specifies the inferred value of the variable NumRefIdxActive[0] for P or B slices with num_ref_idx_active_override_flag equal to 0, and, when i is equal to 1, specifies the inferred value of NumRefIdxActive[1] for B slices with num_ref_idx_active_override_flag equal to 0. The value of num_ref_idx_default_active_minus1[i] shall be in the range of 0 to 14, inclusive.

rpl1_idx_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that refpic_list_sps_flag[1] and refpic_list_idx[1] are not present in the PH syntax structures or the slice headers for pictures referring to the PPS. rpl1_idx_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that ref_pic_list_sps_flag[1] and refpic_list_idx[1] may be present in the PH syntax structures or the slice headers for pictures referring to the PPS.

init_qp_minus26 plus 26 specifies the initial value of SliceQp_(Y) for each slice referring to the PPS. The initial value of SliceQp_(Y) is modified at the picture level when a non-zero value of ph_qp_delta is decoded or at the slice level when a non-zero value of slice_qp_delta is decoded. The value of init_qp_minus26 shall be in the range of −(26+QpBdOffset) to +37, inclusive.

cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that the ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_intra_slice and ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_inter_slice syntax elements are present in PHs referring to the PPS and cu_qp_delta_abs may be present in the transform unit syntax. cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_intra_slice and ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_inter_slice syntax elements are not present in PHs referring to the PPS and cu_qp_delta_abs is not present in the transform unit syntax.

pps_chroma_tool_offsets_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that chroma tool offsets related syntax elements are present in the PPS RBSP syntax structure. pps_chroma_tool_offsets_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that chroma tool offsets related syntax elements are not present in in the PPS RBSP syntax structure. When ChromaArrayType is equal to 0, the value of pps_chroma_tool_offsets_present_flag shall be equal to 0.

pps_cb_qp_offset and pps_cr_qp_offset specify the offsets to the luma quantization parameter Qp′_(Y) used for deriving Qp′_(Cb) and Qp′_(Cr), respectively. The values of pps_cb_qp_offset and pps_cr_qp_offset shall be in the range of −12 to +12, inclusive. When ChromaArrayType is equal to 0, pps_cb_qp_offset and pps_cr_qp_offset are not used in the decoding process and decoders shall ignore their value. When not present, the values of pps_cb_qp_offset and pps_cr_qp_offset are inferred to be equal to 0.

pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_value and joint_cbcr_qp_offset_list[i] are present in the PPS RBSP syntax structure. pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_value and joint_cbcr_qp_offset_list[i] are not present in the PPS RBSP syntax structure. When ChromaArrayType is equal to 0 or sps_joint_cbcr_enabled_flag is equal to 0, the value of pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_present_flag shall be equal to 0. When not present, the value of pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_present_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

pps_joint_cbr_qp_offset_value specifies the offset to the luma quantization parameter Qp′_(Y) used for deriving Qp′_(CbCr). The value of pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_value shall be in the range of −12 to +12, inclusive. When ChromaArrayType is equal to 0 or sps_joint_cbcr_enabled_flag is equal to 0, pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_value is not used in the decoding process and decoders shall ignore its value. When pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_present_flag is equal to 0, pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_value is not present and is inferred to be equal to 0.

pps_slice_chroma_qp_offsets_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that the slice_cb_qp_offset and slice_cr_qp_offset syntax elements are present in the associated slice headers. pps_slice_chroma_qp_offsets_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that the slice_cb_qp_offset and slice_cr_qp_offset syntax elements are not present in the associated slice headers. When not present, the value of pps_slice_chroma_qp_offsets_present_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

pps_cu_chroma_qp_offset_list_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that the ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_intra_slice and ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_inter_slice syntax elements are present in PHs referring to the PPS and cu_chroma_qp_offset_flag may be present in the transform unit syntax and the palette coding syntax. pps_cu_chroma_qp_offset_list_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_intra_slice and ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_inter_slice syntax elements are not present in PHs referring to the PPS and the cu_chroma_qp_offset_flag is not present in the transform unit syntax and the palette coding syntax. When not present, the value of pps_cu_chroma_qp_offset_list_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

chroma_qp_offset_list_len_minus1 plus 1 specifies the number of cb_qp_offset_list[i], cr_qp_offset_list[i], and joint_cbcr_qp_offset_list[i], syntax elements that are present in the PPS RBSP syntax structure. The value of chroma_qp_offset_list_len_minus1 shall be in the range of 0 to 5, inclusive.

cb_qp_offset_list[i], cr_qp_offset_list[i], and joint_cbcr_qp_offset_list[i], specify offsets used in the derivation of Qp′_(Cb), Qp′_(Cr), and Qp′_(CbCr), respectively. The values of cb_qp_offset_list[i], cr_qp_offset_list[i], and joint_cbcr_qp_offset_list[i] shall be in the range of −12 to +12, inclusive. When pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_present_flag is equal to 0, joint_cbcr_qp_offset_list[i] is not present and it is inferred to be equal to 0.

pps_weighted_pred_flag equal to 0 specifies that weighted prediction is not applied to P slices referring to the PPS. pps_weighted_pred_flag equal to 1 specifies that weighted prediction is applied to P slices referring to the PPS. When sps_weighted_pred_flag is equal to 0, the value of pps_weighted_pred_flag shall be equal to 0.

pps_weighted_bipred_flag equal to 0 specifies that explicit weighted prediction is not applied to B slices referring to the PPS. pps_weighted_bipred_flag equal to 1 specifies that explicit weighted prediction is applied to B slices referring to the PPS. When sps_weighted_bipred_flag is equal to 0, the value of pps_weighted_bipred_flag shall be equal to 0.

deblocking_filter_control_present_flag equal to 1 specifies the presence of deblocking filter control syntax elements in the PPS. deblocking_filter_control_present_flag equal to 0 specifies the absence of deblocking filter control syntax elements in the PPS.

deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies the presence of ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag in the PHs referring to the PPS or slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag in the slice headers referring to the PPS. deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies the absence of ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag in PHs referring to the PPS or slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag in slice headers referring to the PPS. When not present, the value of deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that the operation of deblocking filter is not applied for slices referring to the PPS in which slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not present. pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the operation of the deblocking filter is applied for slices referring to the PPS in which slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not present. When not present, the value of pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

pps_beta_offset_div2 and pps_tc_offset_div2 specify the default deblocking parameter offsets for β and tC (divided by 2) that are applied to the luma component for slices referring to the PPS, unless the default deblocking parameter offsets are overridden by the deblocking parameter offsets present in the picture headers or the slice headers of the slices referring to the PPS. The values of pps_beta_offset_div2 and pps_tc_offset_div2 shall both be in the range of −12 to 12, inclusive. When not present, the values of pps_beta_offset_div2 and pps_tc_offset_div2 are both inferred to be equal to 0.

pps_cb_beta_offset_div2 and pps_cb_tc_offset_div2 specify the default deblocking parameter offsets for β and tC (divided by 2) that are applied to the Cb component for slices referring to the PPS, unless the default deblocking parameter offsets are overridden by the deblocking parameter offsets present in the picture headers or the slice headers of the slices referring to the PPS. The values of pps_cb_beta_offset_div2 and pps_cb_tc_offset_div2 shall both be in the range of −12 to 12, inclusive. When not present, the values of pps_cb_beta_offset_div2 and pps_cb_tc_offset_div2 are both inferred to be equal to 0.

pps_cr_beta_offset_div2 and pps_cr_tc_offset_div2 specify the default deblocking parameter offsets for β and tC (divided by 2) that are applied to the Cr component for slices referring to the PPS, unless the default deblocking parameter offsets are overridden by the deblocking parameter offsets present in the picture headers or the slice headers of the slices referring to the PPS. The values of pps_cr_beta_offset_div2 and pps_cr_tc_offset_div2 shall both be in the range of −12 to 12, inclusive. When not present, the values of pps_cr_beta_offset_div2 and pps_cr_tc_offset_div2 are both inferred to be equal to 0.

rpl_info_in_ph_flag equal to 1 specifies that reference picture list information is present in the PH syntax structure and not present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure. rpl_info_in_ph_flag equal to 0 specifies that reference picture list information is not present in the PH syntax structure and may be present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure.

dbf_info_in_ph_flag equal to 1 specifies that deblocking filter information is present in the PH syntax structure and not present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure. dbf_info_in_ph_flag equal to 0 specifies that deblocking filter information is not present in the PH syntax structure and may be present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure. When not present, the value of dbf_info_in_ph_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

sao_info_in_ph_flag equal to 1 specifies that SAO filter information is present in the PH syntax structure and not present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure. sao_info_in_ph_flag equal to 0 specifies that SAO filter information is not present in the PH syntax structure and may be present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure.

alf_info_in_ph_flag equal to 1 specifies that ALF information is present in the PH syntax structure and not present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure. alf_info_in_ph_flag equal to 0 specifies that ALF information is not present in the PH syntax structure and may be present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure.

wp_info_in_ph_flag equal to 1 specifies that weighted prediction information may be present in the PH syntax structure and not present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure.

wp_info_in_ph_flag equal to 0 specifies that weighted prediction information is not present in the PH syntax structure and may be present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure. When not present, the value of wp_info_in_ph_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

qp_delta_info_in_ph_flag equal to 1 specifies that QP delta information is present in the PH syntax structure and not present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure. qp_delta_info_in_ph_flag equal to 0 specifies that QP delta information is not present in the PH syntax structure and may be present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure.

pps_ref_wraparound_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that horizontal wrap-around motion compensation is applied in inter prediction. pps_ref_wraparound_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that horizontal wrap-around motion compensation is not applied. When the value of CtbSizeY/MinCbSizeY+1 is greater than pic_width_in_luma_samples/MinCbSizeY−1, the value of pps_ref_wraparound_enabled_flag shall be equal to 0. When sps_ref_wraparound_enabled_flag is equal to 0, the value of pps_ref_wraparound_enabled_flag shall be equal to 0.

pps_ref_wraparound_offset plus (CtbSizeY/MinCbSizeY)+2 specifies the offset used for computing the horizontal wrap-around position in units of MinCbSizeY luma samples. The value of pps_ref_wraparound_offset shall be in the range of 0 to (pic_width_in_luma_samples/MinCbSizeY)−(CtbSizeY/MinCbSizeY)−2, inclusive. The variable PpsRefWraparoundOffset is set equal to pps_ref_wraparound_offset+(CtbSizeY/MinCbSizeY)+2.

picture_header_extension_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that no PH extension syntax elements are present in PHs referring to the PPS. picture_header_extension_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that PH extension syntax elements are present in PHs referring to the PPS. picture_header_extension_present_flag shall be equal to 0 in bitstreams conforming to this version of this Specification.

slice_header_extension_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that no slice header extension syntax elements are present in the slice headers for coded pictures referring to the PPS. slice_header_extension_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that slice header extension syntax elements are present in the slice headers for coded pictures referring to the PPS. slice_header_extension_present_flag shall be equal to 0 in bitstreams conforming to this version of this Specification.

pps_extension_flag equal to 0 specifies that no pps_extension_data_flag syntax elements are present in the PPS RBSP syntax structure. pps_extension_flag equal to 1 specifies that there are pps_extension_data_flag syntax elements present in the PPS RBSP syntax structure.

pps_extension_data_flag may have any value. Its presence and value do not affect decoder conformance to profiles specified in this version of this Specification. Decoders conforming to this version of this Specification shall ignore all pps_extension_data_flag syntax elements.

3.2. APS Syntax and Semantics

In the latest VVC draft text, the APS syntax and semantics are as follows:

Descriptor adaptation_parameter_set_rbsp( ) {  adaptation_parameter_set_id u(5)  aps_params_type u(3)  if( aps_params_type = = ALF_APS )   alf_data( )  else if( aps_params_type = = LMCS_APS )   lmcs_data( )  else if( aps_params_type = = SCALING_APS )   scaling_list_data( )  aps_extension_flag u(1)  if( aps_extension_flag)   while( more_rbsp_data( ) )    aps_extension_data_flag u(1)  rbsp_trailing_bits( ) }

The APS RBSP contains a ALF syntax structure, i.e., alf_data( ).

Descriptor alf_data( ) {  alf_luma_filter_signal_flag u(1)  alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag u(1)  alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag u(1)  alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag u(1)  if( alf_luma_filter_signal_flag) {   alf_luma_clip_flag u(1)   alf_luma_num_filters_signalled_minus1 ue(v)   if( alf_luma_num_filters_signalled_minus1 > 0 )    for( filtIdx = 0; filtIdx < NumAlfFilters; filtIdx++)     alf_luma_coeff_delta_idx[ filtIdx ] u(v)   for( sfIdx= 0; sfIdx <=   alf_luma_num_filters_signalled_minus1; sfIdx++ )    for( j = 0; j < 12; j++ ){     alf_luma_coeff_abs[ sfIdx ][ j ] ue(v)     if( alf_luma_coeff_abs[ sfIdx ][ j ])      alf_luma_coeff_sign[ sfIdx ][ j ] u(1)    }   if( alf_luma_clip_flag )    for( sfIdx = 0; sfIdx <=    alf_luma_num_filters_signalled_minus1; sfIdx++)     for( j = 0; j< 12; j++ )      alf_luma_clip_idx[ sfIdx ] [ j ] u(2)    }   if( alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag) {   alf_chroma_clip_flag u(1)   alf_chroma_num_alt_filters_minus1 ue(v)   for( altIdx = 0; altIdx <=   alf_chroma_num_alt_filters_minus1; altIdx++ ) {    for( j = 0; j < 6; j++ ) {     alf_chroma_coeff_abs[ altIdx ][ j ] ue(v)     if( alf_chroma_coeff_abs[ altIdx ][ j ] > 0 )      alf_chroma_coeff_sign[ altIdx ][ j ] u(1)    }    if( alf_chroma_clip_flag )     for( j = 0; j < 6; j++ )      alf_chroma_clip_idx[ altIdx ] [ j ] u(2)   }  }  if( alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag ) {   alf_cc_cb_filters_signalled_minus1 ue(v)   for( k = 0; k <   alf_cc_cb_filters_signalled_minus1 + 1; k++ ) {    for( j = 0; j < 7; j++ ) {      alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs[ k ][ j ] u(3)     if( alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs[ k ][ j ])     alf_cc_cb_coeff_sign[ k ] [ j ] u(1)    }   }  }  if( alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag ) {   alf_cc_cr_filters_signalleed_minus1 ue(v)   for( k = 0; k <    alf_cc_cr_filters_signalled_minus1 + 1; k++ ) {    for( j = 0; j < 7; j++ ) {     alf_cc_cr_mapped_coeff_abs[ k ][ j ] u(3)     if( alf_cc_cr_mapped_coeff_abs[ k ][ j ])      alf_cc_cr_coeff_sign[ k ] [ j ] u(1)    }   }  } }

The APS RBSP contains a LMCS syntax structure, i.e., lmcs_data( ).

Descriptor lmcs_data( ) {  lmcs_min_bin_idx ue(v)  lmcs_delta_max_bin_idx ue(v)  lmcs_delta_cw_prec_minus1 ue(v)  for( i = lmcs_min_bin_idx; i <= LmcsMaxBinIdx; i++ ) {   lmcs_delta_abs_cw[ i ] u(v)   if( lmcs_delta_abs_cw[ i ] > 0 )    lmcs_delta_sign_cw_flag[ i ] u(1)  }  lmcs_delta_abs_crs u(3)  if( lmcs_delta_abs_crs > 0 )   lmcs_delta_sign_crs_flag u(1) }

The APS RBSP contains a scaling list data syntax structure, i.e., scaling_list_data( ).

Descriptor scaling_list_data( ) {  scaling_matrix_for_lfnst_disabled_flag u(1)  scaling_list_chroma_present_flag u(1)  for( id = 0; id < 28; id ++ )   matrixSize = (id < 2 ) ? 2 : ( ( id < 8 ) ? 4 : 8 )   if( scaling_list_chroma_present_flag | | (id % 3 = = 2 ) | | ( id = = 27 ) ) {    scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[ id ] u(1)    if( !scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[ id ] )     scaling_list_pred_mode_flag[ id ] u(1)    if( ( scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[ id ] | | scaling_list_pred_mode_flag[ id ] ) &&      id != 0 && id != 2 && id != 8 )     scaling_list_pred_id_delta[ id ] ue(v)    if( !scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[ id ] ) {     nextCoef = 0     if( id > 13 ) {      scaling_list_dc_coef[ id − 14 ] se(v)      nextCoef += scaling_list_dc_coef[ id − 14 ]     }     for( i = 0; i < matrixSize * matrixSize; i++ ) {      x = DiagScanOrder[ 3 ][ 3 ][ i ][ 0 ]      y = DiagScanOrder[ 3 ][ 3 ][ i ][ 1 ]      if( !(id > 25 && x >= 4 && y >= 4 ) ) {       scaling_list_delta_coef[ id ][ i ] se(v)       nextCoef += scaling_list_delta_coef[ id ][ i ]      }      ScalingList[ id ][ i ] = nextCoef     }    }   }  } }

Each APS RBSP shall be available to the decoding process prior to it being referenced, included in at least one AU with TemporalId less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit that refers it or provided through external means.

All APS NAL units with a particular value of adaptation_parameter_set_id and a particular value of aps_params_type within a PU, regardless of whether they are prefix or suffix APS NAL units, shall have the same content.

adaptation_parameter_set_id provides an identifier for the APS for reference by other syntax elements.

When aps_params_type is equal to ALF_APS or SCALING_APS, the value of adaptation_parameter_set_id shall be in the range of 0 to 7, inclusive.

When aps_params_type is equal to LMCS_APS, the value of adaptation_parameter_set_id shall be in the range of 0 to 3, inclusive.

Let apsLayerId be the value of the nuh_layer_id of a particular APS NAL unit, and vclLayerId be the value of the nuh_layer_id of a particular VCL NAL unit. The particular VCL NAL unit shall not refer to the particular APS NAL unit unless apsLayerId is less than or equal to vclLayerId and the layer with nuh_layer_id equal to apsLayerId is included in at least one OLS that includes the layer with nuh_layer_id equal to vclLayerId.

aps_params_type specifies the type of APS parameters carried in the APS as specified in Table 6.

TABLE 6 APS parameters type codes and types of APS parameters Name of aps_params_type aps_params_type Type of APS parameters 0 ALF_APS ALF parameters 1 LMCS_APS LMCS parameters 2 SCALING_APS Scaling list parameters 3 . . . 7 Reserved Reserved

All APS NAL units with a particular value of aps_params_type, regardless of the nuh_layer_id values, share the same value space for adaptation_parameter_set_id. APS NAL units with different values of aps_params_type use separate values spaces for adaptation_parameter_set_id.

-   -   NOTE 1—An APS NAL unit (with a particular value of         adaptation_parameter_set_id and a particular value of         aps_params_type) can be shared across pictures, and different         slices within a picture can refer to different ALF APSs.     -   NOTE 2—A suffix APS NAL unit associated with a particular VCL         NAL unit (this VCL NAL unit precedes the suffix APS NAL unit in         decoding order) is not for use by the particular VCL NAL unit,         but for use by VCL NAL units following the suffix APS NAL unit         in decoding order.

aps_extension_flag equal to 0 specifies that no aps_extension_data_flag syntax elements are present in the APS RBSP syntax structure. aps_extension_flag equal to 1 specifies that there are aps_extension_data_flag syntax elements present in the APS RBSP syntax structure.

aps_extension_data_flag may have any value. Its presence and value do not affect decoder conformance to profiles specified in this version of this Specification. Decoders conforming to this version of this Specification shall ignore all aps_extension_data_flag syntax elements.

alf_luma_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that a luma filter set is signalled. alf_luma_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that a luma filter set is not signalled.

alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that a chroma filter is signalled. alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that a chroma filter is not signalled. When ChromaArrayType is equal to 0, alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag shall be equal to 0.

At least one of the values of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag, alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag, alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag and alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag shall be equal to 1.

The variable NumAlfFilters specifying the number of different adaptive loop filters is set equal to 25.

alf_luma_clip_flag equal to 0 specifies that linear adaptive loop filtering is applied on luma component. alf_luma_clip_flag equal to 1 specifies that non-linear adaptive loop filtering may be applied on luma component.

alf_luma_num_filters_signalled_minus1 plus 1 specifies the number of adaptive loop filter classes for which luma coefficients can be signalled. The value of alf_luma_num_filters_signalled_minus1 shall be in the range of 0 to NumAlfFilters−1, inclusive.

alf_luma_coeff_delta_idx[filtIdx] specifies the indices of the signalled adaptive loop filter luma coefficient deltas for the filter class indicated by filtIdx ranging from 0 to NumAlfFilters−1. When alf_luma_coeff_delta_idx[filtIdx] is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0. The length of alf_luma_coeff_delta_idx[filtIdx] is Ceil(Log 2(alf_luma_num_filters_signalled_minus1+1)) bits. The value of alf_luma_coeff_delta_idx[filtIdx] shall be in the range of 0 to alf_luma_num_filters_signalled_minus1, inclusive.

alf_luma_coeff_abs[sfIdx][j] specifies the absolute value of the j-th coefficient of the signalled luma filter indicated by sfIdx. When alf_luma_coeff_abs[sfIdx][j] is not present, it is inferred to be equal 0. The value of alf_luma_coeff_abs[sfIdx][j] shall be in the range of 0 to 128, inclusive.

alf_luma_coeff_sign[sfIdx][j] specifies the sign of the j-th luma coefficient of the filter indicated by sfIdx as follows:

-   -   If alf_luma_coeff_sign[sfIdx][j] is equal to 0, the         corresponding luma filter coefficient has a positive value.     -   Otherwise (alf_luma_coeff_sign[sfIdx][j] is equal to 1), the         corresponding luma filter coefficient has a negative value.

When alf_luma_coeff_sign[sfIdx][j] is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

The variable filtCoeff[sfIdx][j] with sfIdx=0..alf_luma_num_filters_signalled_minus1, j=0..11 is initialized as follows:

filtCoeff[sfIdx][j]=alf_luma_coeff_abs[sfIdx][j]*(1−2*alf_luma_coeff_sign[sfIdx][j])  (93)

The luma filter coefficients AlfCoeff_(L)[adaptation_parameter_set_id] with elements AlfCoeff_(L)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][filtIdx][j], with filtIdx=0..NumAlfFilters−1 and j=0..11 are derived as follows:

AlfCoeff_(L)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][filtIdx][j]=filtCoeff[alf_luma_coeff_delta_idx[filtIdx]][j]  (94)

The fixed filter coefficients AlfFixFiltCoeff[i][j] with i=0..64, j=0..11 and the class to filter mapping AlfClassToFiltMap[m][n] with m=0..15 and n=0.24 are derived as follows:

AlfFixFiltCoeff = (95) { { 0, 0, 2, −3, 1, −4, 1, 7, −1, 1, −1,  5} { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, −1, 0, 1, 0, 0, −1,  2} { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0,  0} { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, −1,  1} {2, 2, −7, −3, 0, −5, 13, 22, 12, −3, −3, 17} {−1, 0, 6, −8, 1, −5, 1, 23, 0, 2, −5, 10} {0, 0, −1, −1, 0, −1, 2, 1, 0, 0, −1,  4} {0, 0, 3, −11, 1, 0, −1, 35, 5, 2, −9,  9} {0, 0, 8, −8, −2, −7, 4, 4, 2, 1, −1, 25} {0, 0, 1, −1, 0, −3, 1, 3, −1, 1, −1,  3} {0, 0, 3, −3, 0, −6, 5, −1, 2, 1, −4, 21} {−7, 1, 5, 4, −3, 5, 11, 13, 12, −8, 11, 12} {−7, −3, 6, −2, −3, 8, 14, 15, 2, −7, 11, 16} {2, −1, −6, −5, −2, −2, 20, 14, −4, 0, −3, 25} {3, 1, −8, −4, 0, −8, 22, 5, −3, 2, −10, 29} {2, 1, −7, −1, 2, −11, 23, −5, 0, 2, −10, 29} {−6, −3, 8, 9, −4, 8, 9, 7, 14, −2, 8,  9} {2, 1, −4, −7, 0, −8, 17, 22, 1, −1, −4, 23} {3, 0, −5, −7, 0, −7, 15, 18, −5, 0, −5, 27} {2, 0, 0, −7, 1, −10, 13, 13, −4, 2, −7, 24} {3, 3, −13, 4, −2, −5, 9, 21, 25, −2, −3, 12} {−5, −2, 7, −3, −7, 9, 8, 9, 16, −2, 15, 12} {0, −1, 0, −7, −5, 4, 11, 11, 8, −6, 12, 21} {3, −2, −3, −8, −4, −1, 16, 15, −2, −3, 3, 26} {2, 1, −5, −4, −1, −8, 16, 4, −2, 1, −7, 33} {2, 1, −4, −2, 1, −10, 17, −2, 0, 2, −11, 33} {1, −2, 7, −15, −16, 10, 8, 8, 20, 11, 14, 11} {2, 2, 3, −13, −13, 4, 8, 12, 2, −3, 16, 24} {1, 4, 0, −7, −8, −4, 9, 9, −2, −2, 8, 29} {1, 1, 2, −4, −1, −6, 6, 3, −1, −1, −3, 30} {−7, 3, 2, 10, −2, 3, 7, 11, 19, −7, 8, 10} {0, −2, −5, −3, −2, 4, 20, 15, −1, −3, −1, 22} {3, −1, −8, −4, −1, −4, 22, 8, −4, 2, −8, 28} {0, 3, −14, 3, 0, 1, 19, 17, 8, −3, −7, 20} {0, 2, −1, −8, 3, −6, 5, 21, 1, 1, −9, 13} {−4, −2, 8, 20, −2, 2, 3, 5, 21, 4, 6,  1} {2, −2, −3, −9, −4, 2, 14, 16, 3, −6, 8, 24} {2, 1, 5, −16, −7, 2, 3, 11, 15, −3, 11, 22} {1, 2, 3, −11, −2, −5, 4, 8, 9, −3, −2, 26} {0, −1, 10, −9, −1, −8, 2, 3, 4, 0, 0, 29} {1, 2, 0, −5, 1, −9, 9, 3, 0, 1, −7, 20} {−2, 8, −6, −4, 3, −9, −, 45, 14, 2, −13,  7} {1, −1, 16, −19, −8, −4, −3, 2, 19, 0, 4, 30} {1, 1, −3, 0, 2, −11, 15, −5, 1, 2, −9, 24} {0, 1, −2, 0, 1, −4, 4, 0, 0, 1, −4,  7} {0, 1, 2, −5, 1, −6, 4, 10, −2, 1, −4, 10} {3, 0, −3, −6, −2, −6, 14, 8, −1, −1, −3, 31} {0, 1, 0, −2, 1, −6, 5, 1, 0, 1, −5, 13} {3, 1, 9, −19, −21, 9, 7, 6, 13, 5, 15, 21} {2, 4, 3, −12, −13, 1, 7, 8, 3, 0, 12, 26} {3, 1, −8, −2, 0, −6, 18, 2, −2, 3, −10, 23} {1, 1, −4, −1, 1, −5, 8, 1, −1, 2, −5, 10} {0, 1, −1, 0, 0, −2, 2, 0, 0, 1, −2,  3} {1, 1, −2, −7, 1, −7, 14, 18, 0, 0, −7, 21} {0, 1, 0, −2, 0, −7, 8, 1, −2, 0, −3, 24} {0, 1, 1, −2, 2, −10, 10, 0, −2, 1, −7, 23} {0, 2, 2, −11, 2, −4, −3, 39, 7, 1, −10,  9} {1, 0, 13, −16, −5, −6, −1, 8, 6, 0, 6, 29} {1, 3, 1, −6, −4, −7, 9, 6, −3, −2, 3, 33} {4, 0, −17, −1, −1, 5, 26, 8, −2, 3, −15, 30} {0, 1, −2, 0, 2, −8, 12, −6, 1, 1, −6, 16} {0, 0, 0, −1, 1, −4, 4, 0, 0, 0, −3, 11} {0, 1, 2, −8, 2, −6, 5, 15, 0, 2, −7,  9} {1, −1, 12, −15, −7, −2, 3, 6, 6, −1, 7, 30} },

AlfClassToFiltMap = (96) { {8,  2,  2,  2,  3,  4, 53,  9,  9, 52,  4,  4,  5,  9,  2,  8, 10,  9,  1,  3, 39, 39, 10,  9, 52} {11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 30, 11, 17, 18, 19, 16, 20, 20,  4, 53, 21, 22, 23, 14, 25, 26, 26, 27, 28, 10} {16, 12, 31, 32, 14, 16, 30, 33, 53, 34, 35, 16, 20,  4,  7, 16, 21, 36, 18, 19, 21, 26, 37, 38, 39} {35, 11, 13, 14, 43, 35, 16,  4, 34, 62, 35, 35, 30, 56,  7, 35, 21, 38, 24, 40, 16, 21, 48, 57, 39} {11, 31, 32, 43, 44, 16,  4, 17, 34, 45, 30, 20, 20,  7,  5, 21, 22, 46, 40, 47, 26, 48, 63, 58, 10} {12, 13, 50, 51, 52, 11, 17, 53, 45,  9, 30,  4, 53, 19,  0, 22, 23, 25, 43, 44, 37, 27, 28, 10, 55} {30, 33, 62, 51, 44, 20, 41, 56, 34, 45, 20, 41, 41, 56,  5, 30, 56, 38, 40, 47, 11, 37, 42, 57,  8} {35, 11, 23, 32, 14, 35, 20,  4, 17, 18, 21, 20, 20, 20,  4, 16, 21, 36, 46, 25, 41, 26, 48, 49, 58} {12, 31, 59, 59,  3, 33, 33, 59, 59, 52,  4, 33, 17, 59, 55, 22, 36, 59, 59, 60, 22, 36, 59, 25, 55} {31, 25, 15, 60, 60, 22, 17, 19, 55, 55, 20, 20, 53, 19, 55, 22, 46, 25, 43, 60, 37, 28, 10, 55, 52} {12, 31, 32, 50, 51, 11, 33, 53, 19, 45, 16,  4,  4, 53,  5, 22, 36, 18, 25, 43, 26, 27, 27, 28, 10} {5,  2, 44, 52,  3,  4, 53, 45,  9,  3,  4, 56,  5,  0,  2,  5, 10, 47, 52,  3, 63, 39, 10,  9, 52} {12, 34, 44, 44,  3, 56, 56, 62, 45,  9, 56, 56,  7,  5,  0, 22, 38, 40, 47, 52, 48, 57, 39, 10,  9} {35, 11, 23, 14, 51, 35, 20, 41, 56, 62, 16, 20, 41, 56,  7, 16, 21, 38, 24, 40, 26, 26, 42, 57, 39} {33, 34, 51, 51, 52, 41, 41, 34, 62,  0, 41, 41, 56,  7,  5, 56, 38, 38, 40, 44, 37, 42, 57, 39, 10} {16, 31, 32, 15, 60, 30,  4, 17, 19, 25, 22, 20,  4, 53, 19, 21, 22, 46, 25, 55, 26, 48, 63, 58, 55}  },

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the values of AlfCoeff_(L)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][filtIdx][j] with filtIdx=0..NumAlfFilters−1, j=0..11 shall be in the range of −2⁷ to 2⁷−1, inclusive.

alf_luma_clip_idx[sfIdx][j] specifies the clipping index of the clipping value to use before multiplying by the j-th coefficient of the signalled luma filter indicated by sfIdx. It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the values of alf_luma_clip_idx[sfIdx][j] with sfIdx=0..alf_luma_num_filters_signalled_minus1 and j=0..11 shall be in the range of 0 to 3, inclusive.

The luma filter clipping values AlfClip_(L)[adaptation_parameter_set_id] with elements AlfClip_(L)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][filtIdx][j], with filtIdx=0..NumAlfFilters−1 and j=0..11 are derived as specified in Table 8 depending on BitDepth and clipIdx set equal to alf_luma_clip_idx[alf_luma_coeff_delta_idx[filtIdx]][j].

alf_chroma_clip_flag equal to 0 specifies that linear adaptive loop filtering is applied on chroma components; alf_chroma_clip_flag equal to 1 specifies that non-linear adaptive loop filtering is applied on chroma components. When not present, alf_chroma_clip_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

alf_chroma_num_alt_filters_minus1 plus 1 specifies the number of alternative filters for chroma components. The value of alf_chroma_num_alt_filters_minus1 shall be in the range of 0 to 7, inclusive.

alf_chroma_coeff_abs[altIdx][j] specifies the absolute value of the j-th chroma filter coefficient for the alternative chroma filter with index altIdx. When alf_chroma_coeff_abs[altIdx][j] is not present, it is inferred to be equal 0. The value of alf_chroma_coeff_abs[sfIdx][j] shall be in the range of 0 to 128, inclusive.

alf_chroma_coeff_sign[altIdx][j] specifies the sign of the j-th chroma filter coefficient for the alternative chroma filter with index altIdx as follows:

-   -   If alf_chroma_coeff_sign[altIdx][j] is equal to 0, the         corresponding chroma filter coefficient has a positive value.     -   Otherwise (alf_chroma_coeff_sign[altIdx][j] is equal to 1), the         corresponding chroma filter coefficient has a negative value.

When alf_chroma_coeff_sign[altIdx][j] is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

The chroma filter coefficients AlfCoeffC[adaptation_parameter_set_id][altIdx] with elements AlfCoeffC[adaptation_parameter_set_id][altIdx][j], with altIdx=0..alf_chroma_num_alt_filters_minus1, j=0..5 are derived as follows:

AlfCoeffC[adaptation_parameter_set_id][altIdx][j]=alf_chroma_coeff_abs[altIdx][j]*(1−2*alf_chroma_coeff_sign[altIdx][j])  (97)

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the values of AlfCoeff_(C)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][altIdx][j] with altIdx=0..alf_chroma_num_alt_filters_minus1, j=0..5 shall be in the range of −2⁷ to 2⁷−1, inclusive.

alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cb colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for Cb colour component are not signalled. When ChromaArrayType is equal to 0, alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag shall be equal to 0.

alf_cc_cb_filters_signalled_minus1 plus 1 specifies the number of cross-component filters for the Cb colour component signalled in the current ALF APS. The value of alf_cc_cb_filters_signalled_minus1 shall be in the range of 0 to 3, inclusive.

alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j] specifies the absolute value of the j-th mapped coefficient of the signalled k-th cross-component filter for the Cb colour component. When alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j] is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

alf_cc_cb_coeff_sign[k][j] specifies the sign of the j-th coefficient of the signalled k-th cross-component filter for the Cb colour component as follows:

-   -   If alf_cc_cb_coeff_sign[k][j] is equal to 0, the corresponding         cross-component filter coefficient has a positive value.     -   Otherwise (alf_cc_cb_sign[k][j] is equal to 1), the         corresponding cross-component filter coefficient has a negative         value.

When alf_cc_cb_coeff_sign[k][j] is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

The signalled k-th cross-component filter coefficients for the Cb colour component CcAlfApsCoeff_(Cb)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][k][j], with j=0..6 are derived as follows:

-   -   If alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j] is equal to 0,         CcAlfApsCoeff_(Cb)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][k][j] is set         equal to 0.     -   Otherwise, CcAlfApsCoeff_(Cb)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][k][j]         is set equal to         (1−2*alf_cc_cb_coeff_sign[k][j])*2^(alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j]−1).

alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are not signalled. When ChromaArrayType is equal to 0, alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag shall be equal to 0.

alf_cc_cr_filters_signalled_minus1 plus 1 specifies the number of cross-component filters for the Cr colour component signalled in the current ALF APS. The value of alf_cc_cr_filters_signalled_minus1 shall be in the range of 0 to 3, inclusive.

alf_cc_cr_mapped coeff_abs[k][j] specifies the absolute value of the j-th mapped coefficient of the signalled k-th cross-component filter for the Cr colour component. When alf_cc_cr_mapped coeff_abs[k][j] is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

alf_cc_cr_coeff_sign[k][j] specifies the sign of the j-th coefficient of the signalled k-th cross-component filter for the Cr colour component as follows:

-   -   If alf_cc_cr_coeff_sign[k][j] is equal to 0, the corresponding         cross-component filter coefficient has a positive value.     -   Otherwise (alf_cc_cr_sign[k][j] is equal to 1), the         corresponding cross-component filter coefficient has a negative         value.

When alf_cc_cr_coeff_sign[k][j] is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

The signalled k-th cross-component filter coefficients for the Cr colour component

CcAlfApsCoeff_(Cr)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][k][j], with j=0..6 are derived as follows:

-   -   If alf_cc_cr_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j] is equal to 0,         CcAlfApsCoeff_(Cr)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][k][j] is set         equal to 0.     -   Otherwise, CcAlfApsCoeff_(Cr)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][k][j]         is set equal to         (1−2*alf_cc_cr_coeff_sign[k][j])*2^(alf_cc_cr_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j]−1).

alf_chroma_clip_idx[altIdx][j] specifies the clipping index of the clipping value to use before multiplying by the j-th coefficient of the alternative chroma filter with index altIdx. It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the values of alf_chroma_clip_idx[altIdx][j] with altIdx=0..alf_chroma_num_alt_filters_minus1, j=0..5 shall be in the range of 0 to 3, inclusive.

The chroma filter clipping values AlfClip_(C)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][altIdx] with elements AlfClip_(C)[adaptation_parameter_set_id][altIdx][j], with altIdx=0..alf_chroma_num_alt_filters_minus1, j=0..5 are derived as specified in Table 8 depending on BitDepth and clipIdx set equal to alf_chroma_clip_idx[altIdx][j].

TABLE 8 Specification AlfClip depending on BitDepth and clipIdx clipIdx BitDepth 0 1 2 3 8 2⁸  2⁵ 2³ 2¹ 9 2⁹  2⁶ 2⁴ 2² 10 2¹⁰ 2⁷ 2⁵ 2³ 11 2¹¹ 2⁸ 2⁶ 2⁴ 12 2¹² 2⁹ 2⁷ 2⁵ 13 2¹³  2¹⁰ 2⁸ 2⁶ 14 2¹⁴  2¹¹ 2⁹ 2⁷ 15 2¹⁵  2¹²  2¹⁰ 2⁸ 16 2¹⁶  2¹³  2¹¹ 2⁹ lmcs_min_bin_idx specifies the minimum bin index used in the luma mapping with chroma scaling construction process. The value of lmcs_min_bin_idx shall be in the range of 0 to 15, inclusive.

lmcs_delta_max_bin_idx specifies the delta value between 15 and the maximum bin index LmcsMaxBinIdx used in the luma mapping with chroma scaling construction process. The value of lmcs_delta_max_bin_idx shall be in the range of 0 to 15, inclusive. The value of LmcsMaxBinIdx is set equal to 15−lmcs_delta_max_bin_idx. The value of LmcsMaxBinIdx shall be greater than or equal to lmcs_min_bin_idx.

lmcs_delta_cw_prec_minus1 plus 1 specifies the number of bits used for the representation of the syntax lmcs_delta_abs_cw[i]. The value of lmcs_delta_cw_prec_minus1 shall be in the range of 0 to BitDepth−2, inclusive.

lmcs_delta_abs_cw[i] specifies the absolute delta codeword value for the ith bin.

lmcs_delta_sign_cw_flag[i] specifies the sign of the variable lmcsDeltaCW[i] as follows:

-   -   If lmcs_delta_sign_cw_flag[i] is equal to 0, lmcsDeltaCW[i] is a         positive value.     -   Otherwise (lmcs_delta_sign_cw_flag[i] is not equal to 0),         lmcsDeltaCW[i] is a negative value.

When lmcs_delta_sign_cw_flag[i] is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

The variable OrgCW is derived as follows:

OrgCW=(1<<BitDepth)/16  (98)

The variable lmcsDeltaCW[i], with i=lmcs_min_bin_idx..LmcsMaxBinIdx, is derived as follows:

lmcsDeltaCW[i]=(1−2*lmcs_delta_sign_cw_flag[i])*lmcs_delta_abs_cw[i]  (99)

The variable lmcsCW[i] is derived as follows:

-   -   For i=0..lmcs_min_bin_idx−1, lmcsCW[i] is set equal 0.     -   For i=lmcs_min_bin_idx..LmcsMaxBinIdx, the following applies:

lmcsCW[i]=OrgCW+lmcsDeltaCW[i]  (100)

-   -   The value of lmcsCW[i] shall be in the range of (OrgCW>>3) to         (OrgCW<<3−1), inclusive.     -   For i=LmcsMaxBinIdx+1..15, lmcsCW[i] is set equal 0.

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the following condition is true:

Σ_(i=0) ¹⁵lmcsCW[i]<=(1<<BitDepth)−1  (101)

The variable InputPivot[i], with i=0..16, is derived as follows:

InputPivot[i]=i*OrgCW  (102)

The variable LmcsPivot[i] with i=0..16, the variables ScaleCoeff[i] and InvScaleCoeff[i] with i=0..15, are derived as follows:

LmcsPivot[ 0 ] = 0; for( i = 0; i <= 15; i++ ) {  LmcsPivot[ i + 1 ] = LmcsPivot[ i ] + lmcsCW[ i ]  ScaleCoeff[ i ] = ( lmcsCW[ i ] * (1 << 11 ) + ( 1 << ( Log2( OrgCW ) − 1 ) ) ) >> ( Log2( OrgCW ) )  if( lmcsCW[ i ] = = 0 )   (103)   InvScaleCoeff[ i ] = 0  else   InvScaleCoeff[ i ] = OrgCW * ( 1 << 11 ) / lmcsCW[ i ] }

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that, for i=lmcs_min_bin_idx..LmcsMaxBinIdx, when the value of LmcsPivot[i] is not a multiple of 1<<(BitDepth−5), the value of (LmcsPivot[i]>>(BitDepth−5)) shall not be equal to the value of (LmcsPivot[i+1]>>(BitDepth−5)).

lmcs_delta_abs_crs specifies the absolute codeword value of the variable lmcsDeltaCrs. The value of lmcs_delta_abs_crs shall be in the range of 0 and 7, inclusive. When not present, lmcs_delta_abs_crs is inferred to be equal to 0.

lmcs_delta_sign_crs_flag specifies the sign of the variable lmcsDeltaCrs. When not present, lmcs_delta_sign_crs_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

The variable lmcsDeltaCrs is derived as follows:

lmcsDeltaCrs=(1−2*lmcs_delta_sign_crs_flag)*lmcs_delta_abs_crs  (104)

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that, when lmcsCW[i] is not equal to 0, (lmcsCW[i]+lmcsDeltaCrs) shall be in the range of (OrgCW>>3) to ((OrgCW<<3)−1), inclusive.

The variable ChromaScaleCoeff[i], with i=0 . . . 15, is derived as follows:

if( lmcsCW[ i ] = = 0 )  ChromaScaleCoeff[ i ] = ( 1 << 11 ) else  ChromaScaleCoeff[ i ] = OrgCW * ( 1 << 11 ) / ( lmcsCW[ i ] + lmcsDeltaCrs )

scaling_matrix_for_lfnst_disabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that scaling matrices are not applied to blocks coded with LFNST. scaling_matrix_for_lfnst_disabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the scaling matrices may apply to the blocks coded with LFNST.

scaling_list_chroma_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that chroma scaling lists are present in scaling_list_data( ). scaling_list_chroma_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that chroma scaling lists are not present in scaling_list_data( ). It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that scaling_list_chroma_present_flag shall be equal to 0 when ChromaArrayType is equal to 0, and shall be equal to 1 when ChromaArrayType is not equal to 0.

scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[id] equal to 1 specifies that the values of the scaling list are the same as the values of a reference scaling list. The reference scaling list is specified by scaling_list_pred_id_delta[id]. scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[id] equal to 0 specifies that scaling_list_pred_mode_flag is present.

scaling_list_pred_mode_flag[id] equal to 1 specifies that the values of the scaling list can be predicted from a reference scaling list. The reference scaling list is specified by scaling_list_pred_id_delta[id].

scaling_list_pred_mode_flag[id] equal to 0 specifies that the values of the scaling list are explicitly signalled.

When not present, the value of scaling_list_pred_mode_flag[id] is inferred to be equal to 0.

scaling_list_pred_id_delta[id] specifies the reference scaling list used to derive the predicted scaling matrix ScalingMatrixPred[id]. When not present, the value of scaling_list_pred_id_delta[id] is inferred to be equal to 0.

The value of scaling_list_pred_id_delta[id] shall be in the range of 0 to maxIdDelta with maxIdDelta derived depending on id as follows:

maxIdDelta=(id<2)?id:((id<8)?(id−2):(id−8))  (106)

The variables refId and matrixSize are derived as follows:

refId=id−scaling_list_pred_id_delta[id]  (107)

matrixSize=(id<2)?2:((id<8)?4:8)  (108)

The (matrixSize)×(matrixSize) array ScalingMatrixPred[x][y] with x=0..matrixSize−1, y=0..matrixSize−1 and the variable ScalingMatrixDCPred are derived as follows:

-   -   When both scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[id] and         scaling_list_pred_mode_flag[id] are equal to 0, all elements of         ScalingMatrixPred are set equal to 8, and the value of         ScalingMatrixDCPred is set equal to 8.     -   Otherwise, when scaling_list_pred_id_delta[id] is equal to 0,         all elements of ScalingMatrixPred are set equal to 16, and         ScalingMatrixDCPred is set equal to 16.     -   Otherwise (either scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[id] or         scaling_list_pred_mode_flag[id] is equal to 1 and         scaling_list_pred_id_delta[id] is greater than 0),         ScalingMatrixPred is set equal to ScalingMatrixRec[refId], and         the following applies for ScalingMatrixDCPred:         -   If refId is greater than 13, ScalingMatrixDCPred is set             equal to ScalingMatrixDCRec[refId−14].         -   Otherwise (refId is less than or equal to 13),             ScalingMatrixDCPred is set equal to ScalingMatrixPred[0][0].

scaling_list_dc_coef[id−14] is used to derive the value of the variable ScalingMatrixDC[id−14] when id is greater than 13 as follows:

ScalingMatrixDCRec[id−14]=(ScalingMatrixDCPred+scaling_list_dc_coef[id−14])&255  (109)

When not present, the value of scaling_list_dc_coef[id−14] is inferred to be equal to 0. The value of scaling_list_dc_coef[id−14] shall be in the range of −128 to 127, inclusive. The value of ScalingMatrixDCRec[id−14] shall be greater than 0.

scaling_list_delta_coef[id][i] specifies the difference between the current matrix coefficient ScalingList[id][i] and the previous matrix coefficient ScalingList[id][i−1], when scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[id] is equal to 0.

The value of scaling_list_delta_coef[id][i] shall be in the range of −128 to 127, inclusive. When scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[id] is equal to 1, all elements of ScalingList[id] are set equal to 0.

The (matrixSize)×(matrixSize) array ScalingMatrixRec[id] is derived as follows:

ScalingMatrixRec[id][x][y]=(ScalingMatrixPred[x][y]+ScalingList[id][k])&255  (110)

-   -   with k=0..(matrixSize*matrixSize−1),         -   x=DiagScanOrder[Log 2(matrixSize)][Log 2(matrixSize)][k][0],             and         -   y=DiagScanOrder[Log 2(matrixSize)][Log 2(matrixSize)][k][1]

The value of ScalingMatrixRec[id][x][y] shall be greater than 0.

3.3. PH Syntax and Semantics

In the latest VVC draft text, the PH syntax and semantics are as follows:

Descriptor picture_header_rbsp( ) {  picture_header_structure( )  rbsp_trailing_bits( ) }

The PH RBSP contains a PH syntax structure, i.e., picture_header_structure( ).

Descriptor picture_header_structure( ) {  gdr_or_irap_pic_flag u(1)  if( gdr_or_irap_pic_flag )   gdr_pic_flag u(1)  ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag u(1)  if( ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag )   ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag u(1)  non_reference_picture_flag u(1)  ph_pic_parameter_set_id ue(v)  ph_pic_order_cnt_lsb u(v)  if( gdr_or_irap_pic_flag )   no_output_of_prior_pics_flag u(1)  if( gdr_pic_flag )   recovery_poc_cnt ue(v)  for( i = 0; i < NumExtraPhBits; i++ )   ph_extra_bit[ i ] u(1)  if( sps_poc_msb_flag ) {   ph_poc_msb_present_flag u(1)   if( ph_poc_msb_present_flag )    poc_msb_val u(v)  }  if( sps_alf_enabled_flag && alf_info_in_ph_flag ) {   ph_alf_enabled_flag u(1)   if( ph_alf_enabled_flag ) {    ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma u(3)    for( i = 0; i < ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma; i++ )     ph_alf_aps_id_luma[ i ] u(3)    if( ChromaArrayType != 0 )     ph_alf_chroma_idc u(2)    if( ph_alf_chroma_idc > 0 )     ph_alf_aps_id_chroma u(3)    if( sps_ccalf_enabled_flag ) {     ph_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag u(1)     if( ph_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag )      ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id u(3)     ph_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag u(1)     if( ph_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag )      ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id u(3)    }   }  }  if( sps_lmcs_enabled_flag ) {   ph_lmcs_enabled_flag u(1)   if( ph_lmcs_enabled_flag ) {    ph_lmcs_aps_id u(2)    if( ChromaArrayType != 0 )     ph_chroma_residual_scale_flag u(1)   }  }  if( sps_scaling_list_enabled_flag ) {   ph_scaling_list_present_flag u(1)   if( ph_scaling_list_present_flag )    ph_scaling_list_aps_id u(3)  }  if( sps_virtual_boundaries_enabled_flag && !sps_virtual_boundaries_present_flag ) {   ph_virtual_boundaries_present_flag u(1)   if( ph_virtual_boundaries_present_flag ) {    ph_num_ver_virtual_boundaries u(2)    for( i = 0; i < ph_num_ver_virtual_boundaries; i++ )     ph_virtual_boundaries_pos_x[ i ] u(13)    ph_num_hor_virtual_boundaries u(2)    for( i = 0; i < ph_num_hor_virtual_boundaries; i++ )     ph_virtual_boundaries_pos_y[ i ] u(13)   }  }  if( output_flag_present_flag )   pic_output_flag u(1)  if( rpl_info_in_ph_flag )   ref_pic_lists( )  if( partition_constraints_override_enabled_flag )   partition_constraints_override_flag u(1)  if( ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag ) {   if( partition_constraints_override_flag ) {    ph_log2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_intra_slice_luma ue(v)    ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_luma ue(v)    if( ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_luma != 0 ) {     ph_log2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_intra_slice_luma ue(v)     ph_log2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_intra_slice_luma ue(v)    }    if( qtbtt_dual_tree_intra_flag ) {     ph_log2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_intra_slice_chroma ue(v)     ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_chroma ue(v)     if( ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_chroma != 0 ) {  ph_log2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_intra_slice_chroma ue(v)  ph_log2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_intra_slice_chroma ue(v)     }    }   }   if( cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag )    ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_intra_slice ue(v)   if( pps_cu_chroma_qp_offset_list_enabled_flag )    ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_intra_slice ue(v)  }  if( ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag ) {   if( partition_constraints_override_flag ) {    ph_log2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_inter_slice ue(v)    ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_inter_slice ue(v)    if( ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_inter_slice != 0 ) {     ph_log2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_inter_slice ue(v)     ph_log2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_inter_slice ue(v)    }   }   if( cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag )    ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_inter_slice ue(v)   if( pps_cu_chroma_qp_offset_list_enabled_flag )    ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_inter_slice ue(v)   if( sps_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag ) {    ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag u(1)    if( ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag && rpl_info_in_ph_flag ) {     ph_collocated_from_l0_flag u(1)     if( ( ph_collocated_from_l0_flag &&      num_ref_entries[ 0 ][ RplsIdx[ 0 ] ] > 1 ) | |      ( !ph_collocated_from_l0_flag &&      num_ref_entries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx[ 1 ] ] > 1 ) )     ph_collocated_ref_idx ue(v)    }   }   mvd_l1_zero_flag u(1)   if( sps_fpel_mmvd_enabled_flag )    ph_fpel_mmvd_enabled_flag u(1)   if( sps_bdof_pic_present_flag )    ph_disable_bdof_flag u(1)   if( sps_dmvr_pic_present_flag )    ph_disable_dmvr_flag u(1)   if( sps_prof_pic_present_flag )    ph_disable_prof_flag u(1)   if( ( pps_weighted_pred_flag | | pps_weighted_bipred_flag ) && wp_info_in_ph_flag )    pred_weight_table( )  }  if( qp_delta_info_in_ph_flag )   ph_qp_delta se(v)  if( sps_joint_cbcr_enabled_flag )   ph_joint_cbcr_sign_flag u(1)  if( sps_sao_enabled_flag && sao_info_in_ph_flag ) {   ph_sao_luma_enabled_flag u(1)   if( ChromaArrayType != 0 )    ph_sao_chroma_enabled_flag u(1)  }  if( sps_dep_quant_enabled_flag )   ph_dep_quant_enabled_flag u(1)  if( sps_sign_data_hiding_enabled_flag && !ph_dep_quant_enabled_flag )   pic_sign_data_hiding_enabled_flag u(1)  if( deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag && dbf_info_in_ph_flag ) {   ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag u(1)   if( ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag ) {    ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag u(1)    if( !ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag ) {     ph_beta_offset_div2 se(v)     ph_tc_offset_div2 se(v)     ph_cb_beta_offset_div2 se(v)     ph_cb_tc_offset_div2 se(v)     ph_cr_beta_offset_div2 se(v)     ph_cr_tc_offset_div2 se(v)    }   }  }  if( picture_header_extension_present_flag ) {   ph_extension_length ue(v)   for( i = 0; i < ph_extension_length; i++)    ph_extension_data_byte[ i ] u(8)  } }

The PH syntax structure contains information that is common for all slices of the coded picture associated with the PH syntax structure.

gdr_or_irap_pic_flag equal to 1 specifies that the current picture is a GDR or IRAP picture. gdr_or_irap_pic_flag equal to 0 specifies that the current picture may or may not be a GDR or IRAP picture.

gdr_pic_flag equal to 1 specifies the picture associated with the PH is a GDR picture. gdr_pic_flag equal to 0 specifies that the picture associated with the PH is not a GDR picture. When not present, the value of gdr_pic_flag is inferred to be equal to 0. When gdr_enabled_flag is equal to 0, the value of gdr_pic_flag shall be equal to 0.

ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag equal to 0 specifies that all coded slices of the picture have slice_type equal to 2. ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag equal to 1 specifies that there may or may not be one or more coded slices in the picture that have slice_type equal to 0 or 1.

ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag equal to 0 specifies that all coded slices of the picture have slice_type equal to 0 or 1. ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag equal to 1 specifies that there may or may not be one or more coded slices in the picture that have slice_type equal to 2. When not present, the value of ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag is inferred to be equal to 1.

-   -   NOTE 1—For bitstreams that are supposed to work subpicture based         bitstream merging without the need of changing PH NAL units, the         encoder is expected to set the values of both         ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag and ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag         equal to 1.

non_reference_picture_flag equal to 1 specifies the picture associated with the PH is never used as a reference picture. non_reference_picture_flag equal to 0 specifies the picture associated with the PH may or may not be used as a reference picture.

ph_pic_parameter_set_id specifies the value of pps_pic_parameter_set_id for the PPS in use. The value of ph_pic_parameter_set_id shall be in the range of 0 to 63, inclusive.

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the value of TemporalId of the PH shall be greater than or equal to the value of TemporalId of the PPS that has pps_pic_parameter_set_id equal to ph_pic_parameter_set_id.

ph_pic_order_cnt_lsb specifies the picture order count modulo MaxPicOrderCntLsb for the current picture. The length of the ph_pic_order_cnt_lsb syntax element is log 2_max_pic_order_cnt_lsb_minus4+4 bits. The value of the ph_pic_order_cnt_lsb shall be in the range of 0 to MaxPicOrderCntLsb−1, inclusive.

no_output_of_prior_pics_flag affects the output of previously-decoded pictures in the DPB after the decoding of a CLVSS picture that is not the first picture in the bitstream as specified in Annex C.

recovery_poc_nt specifies the recovery point of decoded pictures in output order. If the current picture is a GDR picture that is associated with the PH, and there is a picture picA that follows the current GDR picture in decoding order in the CLVS that has PicOrderCntVal equal to the PicOrderCntVal of the current GDR picture plus the value of recovery_poc_cnt, the picture picA is referred to as the recovery point picture. Otherwise, the first picture in output order that has PicOrderCntVal greater than the PicOrderCntVal of the current picture plus the value of recovery_poc_cnt is referred to as the recovery point picture. The recovery point picture shall not precede the current GDR picture in decoding order. The value of recovery_poc_cnt shall be in the range of 0 to MaxPicOrderCntLsb−1, inclusive.

When the current picture is a GDR picture, the variable RpPicOrderCntVal is derived as follows:

RpPicOrderCntVal=PicOrderCntVal+recovery_poc_cnt  (82)

-   -   NOTE 2—When gdr_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and PicOrderCntVal of         the current picture is greater than or equal to RpPicOrderCntVal         of the associated GDR picture, the current and subsequent         decoded pictures in output order are exact match to the         corresponding pictures produced by starting the decoding process         from the previous IRAP picture, when present, preceding the         associated GDR picture in decoding order.

ph_extra_bit[i] may be equal to 1 or 0. Decoders conforming to this version of this Specification shall ignore the value of ph_extra_bit[i]. Its value does not affect decoder conformance to profiles specified in this version of specification.

ph_poc_msb_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that the syntax element poc_msb_val is present in the PH. ph_poc_msb_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that the syntax element poc_msb_val is not present in the PH. When vps_independent_layer_flag[GeneralLayerIdx[nuh_layer_id]] is equal to 0 and there is a picture in the current AU in a reference layer of the current layer, the value of ph_poc_msb_present_flag shall be equal to 0.

poc_msb_val specifies the POC MSB value of the current picture. The length of the syntax element poc_msb_val is poc_msb_len_minus1+1 bits.

ph_alf_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that adaptive loop filter is enabled for all slices associated with the PH and may be applied to Y, Cb, or Cr colour component in the slices. ph_alf_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that adaptive loop filter may be disabled for one, or more, or all slices associated with the PH. When not present, ph_alf_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma specifies the number of ALF APSs that the slices associated with the PH refers to.

ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

The value of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be equal to 1.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with the PH.

ph_alf_chroma_idc equal to 0 specifies that the adaptive loop filter is not applied to Cb and Cr colour components. ph_alf_chroma_idc equal to 1 indicates that the adaptive loop filter is applied to the Cb colour component. ph_alf_chroma_idc equal to 2 indicates that the adaptive loop filter is applied to the Cr colour component. ph_alf_chroma_idc equal to 3 indicates that the adaptive loop filter is applied to Cb and Cr colour components. When ph_alf_chroma_idc is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_alf_aps_id_chroma specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the chroma component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

The value of alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_chroma shall be equal to 1.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_chroma shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with the PH.

ph_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filter for Cb colour component is enabled for all slices associated with the PH and may be applied to Cb colour component in the slices. ph_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filter for Cb colour component may be disabled for one, or more, or all slices associated with the PH. When not present, ph_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the Cb colour component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

The value of alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be equal to 1.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with the PH.

ph_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filter for Cr colour component is enabled for all slices associated with the PH and may be applied to Cr colour component in the slices. ph_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filter for Cr colour component may be disabled for one, or more, or all slices associated with the PH. When not present, ph_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the Cr colour component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

The value of alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be equal to 1.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with the PH.

ph_lmcs_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that luma mapping with chroma scaling is enabled for all slices associated with the PH. ph_lmcs_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that luma mapping with chroma scaling may be disabled for one, or more, or all slices associated with the PH. When not present, the value of ph_lmcs_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_lmcs_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the LMCS APS that the slices associated with the PH refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to LMCS_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_lmcs_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with PH.

ph_chroma_residual_scale_flag equal to 1 specifies that chroma residual scaling is enabled for the all slices associated with the PH. ph_chroma_residual_scale_flag equal to 0 specifies that chroma residual scaling may be disabled for one, or more, or all slices associated with the PH. When ph_chroma_residual_scale_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_scaling_list_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that the scaling list data used for the slices associated with the PH is derived based on the scaling list data contained in the referenced scaling list APS. ph_scaling_list_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that the scaling list data used for the slices associated with the PH is set to be equal to 16. When not present, the value of ph_scaling_list_present_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_scaling_list_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the scaling list APS. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to SCALING_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_scaling_list_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with PH.

ph_virtual_boundaries_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that information of virtual boundaries is signalled in the PH. ph_virtual_boundaries_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that information of virtual boundaries is not signalled in the PH. When there is one or more than one virtual boundaries signalled in the PH, the in-loop filtering operations are disabled across the virtual boundaries in the picture. The in-loop filtering operations include the deblocking filter, sample adaptive offset filter, and adaptive loop filter operations. When not present, the value of ph_virtual_boundaries_present_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that, when subpic_info_present_flag is equal to 1, the value of ph_virtual_boundaries_present_flag shall be equal to 0.

The variable VirtualBoundariesPresentFlag is derived as follows:

-   -   VirtualBoundariesPresentFlag=0     -   if(sps_virtual_boundaries_enabled_flag)

VirtualBoundariesPresentFlag=sps_virtual_boundaries_present_flag∥ph_virtual_boundaries_present_flag  (83)

ph_num_ver_virtual_boundaries specifies the number of ph_virtual_boundaries_pos_x[i] syntax elements that are present in the PH. When ph_num_ver_virtual_boundaries is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

The variable NumVerVirtualBoundaries is derived as follows:

-   -   NumVerVirtualBoundaries=0     -   if(sps_virtual_boundaries_enabled_flag)

NumVerVirtualBoundaries=sps_virtual_boundaries_present_flag?sps_num_ver_virtual_boundaries:ph_num_ver_virtual_boundaries  (84)

ph_virtual_boundaries_pos_x[i] specifies the location of the i-th vertical virtual boundary in units of luma samples divided by 8. The value of ph_virtual_boundaries_pos_x[i] shall be in the range of 1 to Ceil(pic_width_in_luma_samples+8)−1, inclusive.

The list VirtualBoundariesPosX[i] for i ranging from 0 to NumVerVirtualBoundaries−1, inclusive, in units of luma samples, specifying the locations of the vertical virtual boundaries, is derived as follows:

-   -   for(i=0; i<NumVerVirtualBoundaries; i++)

VirtualBoundariesPosX[i]=(sps_virtual_boundaries_present_flag?sps_virtual_boundaries_pos_x[i]:ph_virtual_boundaries_pos_x[i])*8  (85)

The distance between any two vertical virtual boundaries shall be greater than or equal to CtbSizeY luma samples.

ph_num_hor_virtual_boundaries specifies the number of ph_virtual_boundaries_pos_y[i] syntax elements that are present in the PH. When ph_num_hor_virtual_boundaries is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

The parameter NumHorVirtualBoundaries is derived as follows:

-   -   NumHorVirtualBoundaries=0     -   if(sps_virtual_boundaries_enabled_flag)

NumHorVirtualBoundaries=sps_virtual_boundaries_present_flag?sps_num_hor_virtual_boundaries:ph_num_hor_virtual_boundaries  (86)

When sps_virtual_boundaries_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and ph_virtual_boundaries_present_flag is equal to 1, the sum of ph_num_ver_virtual_boundaries and ph_num_hor_virtual_boundaries shall be greater than 0.

ph_virtual_boundaries_pos_y[i] specifies the location of the i-th horizontal virtual boundary in units of luma samples divided by 8. The value of ph_virtual_boundaries_pos_y[i] shall be in the range of 1 to Ceil(pic_height_in_luma_samples+8)−1, inclusive.

The list VirtualBoundariesPosY[i] for i ranging from 0 to NumHorVirtualBoundaries−1, inclusive, in units of luma samples, specifying the locations of the horizontal virtual boundaries, is derived as follows:

-   -   for(i=0; i<NumHorVirtualBoundaries; i++)

VirtualBoundariesPosY[i]=(sps_virtual_boundaries_present_flag?sps_virtual_boundaries_pos_y[i]:ph_virtual_boundaries_pos_y[i])*8  (87)

The distance between any two horizontal virtual boundaries shall be greater than or equal to CtbSizeY luma samples.

pic_output_flag affects the decoded picture output and removal processes as specified in Annex C. When pic_output_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 1.

partition_constraints_override_flag equal to 1 specifies that partition constraint parameters are present in the PH. partition_constraints_override_flag equal to 0 specifies that partition constraint parameters are not present in the PH. When not present, the value of partition_onstraints_override_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_intra_slice_luma specifies the difference between the base 2 logarithm of the minimum size in luma samples of a luma leaf block resulting from quadtree splitting of a CTU and the base 2 logarithm of the minimum coding block size in luma samples for luma CUs in the slices with slice_type equal to 2 (I) associated with the PH. The value of ph_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_intra_slice_luma shall be in the range of 0 to CtbLog 2SizeY−MinCbLog 2SizeY, inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_log 2diff_min_qt_min_cb_luma is inferred to be equal to sps_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_intra_slice_luma.

ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_luma specifies the maximum hierarchy depth for coding units resulting from multi-type tree splitting of a quadtree leaf in slices with slice_type equal to 2 (I) associated with the PH. The value of ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_luma shall be in the range of 0 to 2*(CtbLog 2SizeY−MinCbLog 2SizeY), inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_luma is inferred to be equal to sps_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_luma.

ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_intra_slice_luma specifies the difference between the base 2 logarithm of the maximum size (width or height) in luma samples of a luma coding block that can be split using a binary split and the minimum size (width or height) in luma samples of a luma leaf block resulting from quadtree splitting of a CTU in slices with slice_type equal to 2 (I) associated with the PH. The value of ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_intra_slice_luma shall be in the range of 0 to CtbLog 2SizeY−MinQtLog 2SizeIntraY, inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_intra_slice_luma is inferred to be equal to sps_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_intra_slice_luma.

ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_intra_slice_luma specifies the difference between the base 2 logarithm of the maximum size (width or height) in luma samples of a luma coding block that can be split using a ternary split and the minimum size (width or height) in luma samples of a luma leaf block resulting from quadtree splitting of a CTU in slices with slice_type equal to 2 (I) associated with the PH. The value of ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_intra_slice_luma shall be in the range of 0 to CtbLog 2SizeY−MinQtLog 2SizeIntraY, inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_intra_slice_luma is inferred to be equal to sps_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_intra_slice_luma.

ph_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_intra_slice_chroma specifies the difference between the base 2 logarithm of the minimum size in luma samples of a chroma leaf block resulting from quadtree splitting of a chroma CTU with treeType equal to DUAL_TREE_CHROMA and the base 2 logarithm of the minimum coding block size in luma samples for chroma CUs with treeType equal to DUAL_TREE_CHROMA in slices with slice_type equal to 2 (I) associated with the PH. The value of ph_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_intra_slice_chroma shall be in the range of 0 to CtbLog 2SizeY−MinCbLog 2SizeY, inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_intra_slice_chroma is inferred to be equal to sps_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_intra_slice_chroma.

ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_chroma specifies the maximum hierarchy depth for chroma coding units resulting from multi-type tree splitting of a chroma quadtree leaf with treeType equal to DUAL_TREE_CHROMA in slices with slice_type equal to 2 (I) associated with the PH. The value of ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_chroma shall be in the range of 0 to 2*(CtbLog 2SizeY−MinCbLog 2SizeY), inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_chroma is inferred to be equal to sps_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_chroma.

ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_intra_slice_chroma specifies the difference between the base 2 logarithm of the maximum size (width or height) in luma samples of a chroma coding block that can be split using a binary split and the minimum size (width or height) in luma samples of a chroma leaf block resulting from quadtree splitting of a chroma CTU with treeType equal to DUAL_TREE_CHROMA in slices with slice_type equal to 2 (I) associated with the PH. The value of ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_intra_slice_chroma shall be in the range of 0 to CtbLog 2SizeY−MinQtLog 2SizeIntraC, inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_intra_slice_chroma is inferred to be equal to sps_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_intra_slice_chroma.

ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_intra_slice_chroma specifies the difference between the base 2 logarithm of the maximum size (width or height) in luma samples of a chroma coding block that can be split using a ternary split and the minimum size (width or height) in luma samples of a chroma leaf block resulting from quadtree splitting of a chroma CTU with treeType equal to DUAL_TREE_CHROMA in slices with slice_type equal to 2 (I) associated with the PH. The value of ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_intra_slice_chroma shall be in the range of 0 to CtbLog 2SizeY−MinQtLog 2SizeIntraC, inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_intra_slice_chroma is inferred to be equal to sps_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_intra_slice_chroma

ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_intra_slice specifies the maximum cbSubdiv value of coding units in intra slice that convey cu_qp_delta_abs and cu_qp_delta_sign_flag. The value of ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_intra_slice shall be in the range of 0 to 2*(CtbLog 2SizeY−MinQtLog 2SizeIntraY+ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_luma), inclusive.

When not present, the value of ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_intra_slice is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_intra_slice specifies the maximum cbSubdiv value of coding units in intra slice that convey cu_chroma_qp_offset_flag. The value of ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_intra_slice shall be in the range of 0 to 2*(CtbLog 2SizeY−MinQtLog 2SizeIntraY+ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_luma), inclusive.

When not present, the value of ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_intra_slice is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_inter_slice specifies the difference between the base 2 logarithm of the minimum size in luma samples of a luma leaf block resulting from quadtree splitting of a CTU and the base 2 logarithm of the minimum luma coding block size in luma samples for luma CUs in the slices with slice_type equal to 0 (B) or 1 (P) associated with the PH. The value of ph_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_inter_slice shall be in the range of 0 to CtbLog 2SizeY−MinCbLog 2SizeY, inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_luma is inferred to be equal to sps_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_inter_slice.

ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_inter_slice specifies the maximum hierarchy depth for coding units resulting from multi-type tree splitting of a quadtree leaf in slices with slice_type equal to 0 (B) or 1 (P) associated with the PH. The value of ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_inter_slice shall be in the range of 0 to 2*(CtbLog 2SizeY−MinCbLog 2SizeY), inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_inter_slice is inferred to be equal to sps_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_inter_slice.

ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_inter_slice specifies the difference between the base 2 logarithm of the maximum size (width or height) in luma samples of a luma coding block that can be split using a binary split and the minimum size (width or height) in luma samples of a luma leaf block resulting from quadtree splitting of a CTU in the slices with slice_type equal to 0 (B) or 1 (P) associated with the PH. The value of ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_inter_slice shall be in the range of 0 to CtbLog 2SizeY−MinQtLog 2SizeInterY, inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_inter_slice is inferred to be equal to sps_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_inter_slice.

ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_inter_slice specifies the difference between the base 2 logarithm of the maximum size (width or height) in luma samples of a luma coding block that can be split using a ternary split and the minimum size (width or height) in luma samples of a luma leaf block resulting from quadtree splitting of a CTU in slices with slice_type equal to 0 (B) or 1 (P) associated with the PH. The value of ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_inter_slice shall be in the range of 0 to CtbLog 2SizeY−MinQtLog 2SizeInterY, inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_inter_slice is inferred to be equal to sps_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_inter_slice.

ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_inter_slice specifies the maximum cbSubdiv value of coding units that in inter slice convey cu_qp_delta_abs and cu_qp_delta_sign_flag. The value of ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_inter_slice shall be in the range of 0 to 2*(CtbLog 2SizeY−MinQtLog 2SizeInterY+ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_inter_slice), inclusive.

When not present, the value of ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_inter_slice is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_inter_slice specifies the maximum cbSubdiv value of coding units in inter slice that convey cu_chroma_qp_offset_flag. The value of ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_inter_slice shall be in the range of 0 to 2*(CtbLog 2SizeY−MinQtLog 2SizeInterY+ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_inter_slice), inclusive.

When not present, the value of ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_inter_slice is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag specifies whether temporal motion vector predictors can be used for inter prediction for slices associated with the PH. If ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag is equal to 0, the syntax elements of the slices associated with the PH shall be constrained such that no temporal motion vector predictor is used in decoding of the slices. Otherwise (ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag is equal to 1), temporal motion vector predictors may be used in decoding of the slices associated with the PH. When not present, the value of ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 0. When no reference picture in the DPB has the same spatial resolution as the current picture, the value of ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag shall be equal to 0.

The maximum number of subblock-based merging MVP candidates, MaxNumSubblockMergeCand, is derived as follows:

 if( sps_affine_enabled_flag )   MaxNumSubblockMergeCand = 5 − five_minus_max_num_subblock_merge_cand (88)  else   MaxNumSubblockMergeCand = sps_sbtmvp_enabled_flag && ph_temporal_mvp_   enable_flag The value of MaxNumSubblockMergCand shall be in the reange of 0 to 5, inclusive.

ph_collocated_from_l0_flag equal to 1 specifies that the collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference picture list 0. ph_collocated_from_l0_flag equal to 0 specifies that the collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference picture list 1.

ph_collocated_ref_idx specifies the reference index of the collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction.

When ph_collocated_from_l0_flag is equal to 1, ph_collocated_ref_idx refers to an entry in reference picture list 0, and the value of ph_collocated_ref_idx shall be in the range of 0 to num_ref_entries[0][RplsIdx[0]]−1, inclusive.

When ph_collocated_from_l0_flag is equal to 0, ph_collocated_ref_idx refers to an entry in reference picture list 1, and the value of ph_collocated_ref_idx shall be in the range of 0 to num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]−1, inclusive.

When not present, the value of ph_collocated_ref_idx is inferred to be equal to 0.

mvd_l1_zero_flag equal to 1 indicates that the mvd_coding(x0, y0, 1) syntax structure is not parsed and MvdL1[x0][y0][compIdx] and MvdCpL1[x0][y0][cpIdx][compIdx] are set equal to 0 for compIdx=0..1 and cpIdx=0..2. mvd_l1_zero_flag equal to 0 indicates that the mvd_coding(x0, y0, 1) syntax structure is parsed.

ph_fpel_mmvd_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that merge mode with motion vector difference uses integer sample precision in the slices associated with the PH. ph_fpel_mmvd_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that merge mode with motion vector difference can use fractional sample precision in the slices associated with the PH. When not present, the value of ph_fpel_mmvd_enabled_flag is inferred to be 0.

ph_disable_bdof_flag equal to 1 specifies that bi-directional optical flow inter prediction based inter bi-prediction is disabled in the slices associated with the PH. ph_disable_bdof_flag equal to 0 specifies that bi-directional optical flow inter prediction based inter bi-prediction may or may not be enabled in the slices associated with the PH.

When ph_disable_bdof_flag is not present, the following applies:

-   -   If sps_bdof_enabled_flag is equal to 1, the value of         ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.     -   Otherwise (sps_bdof_enabled_flag is equal to 0), the value of         ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be equal to 1.

ph_disable_dmvr_flag equal to 1 specifies that decoder motion vector refinement based inter bi-prediction is disabled in the slices associated with the PH. ph_disable_dmvr_flag equal to 0 specifies that decoder motion vector refinement based inter bi-prediction may or may not be enabled in the slices associated with the PH.

When ph_disable_dmvr_flag is not present, the following applies:

-   -   If sps_dmvr_enabled_flag is equal to 1, the value of         ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.     -   Otherwise (sps_dmvr_enabled_flag is equal to 0), the value of         ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be equal to 1.

ph_disable_prof_flag equal to 1 specifies that prediction refinement with optical flow is disabled in the slices associated with the PH. ph_disable_prof_flag equal to 0 specifies that prediction refinement with optical flow may or may not be enabled in the slices associated with the PH.

When ph_disable_prof_flag is not present, the following applies:

-   -   If sps_affine_prof_enabled_flag is equal to 1, the value of         ph_disable_prof_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.     -   Otherwise (sps_affine_prof_enabled_flag is equal to 0), the         value of ph_disable_prof_flag is inferred to be equal to 1.

ph_qp_delta specifies the initial value of Qp_(Y) to be used for the coding blocks in the picture until modified by the value of CuQpDeltaVal in the coding unit layer.

When qp_delta_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 1, the initial value of the Qp_(Y) quantization parameter for all slices of the picture, SliceQp_(Y), is derived as follows:

SliceQp_(Y)=26+init_qp_minus26+ph_qp_delta  (89)

The value of SliceQp_(Y) shall be in the range of −QpBdOffset to +63, inclusive.

ph_joint_cber_sign_flag specifies whether, in transform units with tu_joint_cbcr_residual_flag[x0][y0] equal to 1, the collocated residual samples of both chroma components have inverted signs. When tu_joint_cbcr_residual_flag[x0][y0] equal to 1 for a transform unit, ph_joint_cbcr_sign_flag equal to 0 specifies that the sign of each residual sample of the Cr (or Cb) component is identical to the sign of the collocated Cb (or Cr) residual sample and ph_joint_cbcr_sign_flag equal to 1 specifies that the sign of each residual sample of the Cr (or Cb) component is given by the inverted sign of the collocated Cb (or Cr) residual sample.

ph_sao_luma_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that SAO is enabled for the luma component in all slices associated with the PH; ph_sao_luma_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that SAO for the luma component may be disabled for one, or more, or all slices associated with the PH. When ph_sao_luma_enabled_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_sao_chroma_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that SAO is enabled for the chroma component in all slices associated with the PH; ph_sao_chroma_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that SAO for chroma component may be disabled for one, or more, or all slices associated with the PH. When ph_sao_chroma_enabled_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_dep_quant_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that dependent quantization is disabled for the current picture. ph_dep_quant_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that dependent quantization is enabled for the current picture. When ph_dep_quant_enabled_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

pic_sign_data_hiding_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that sign bit hiding is disabled for the current picture. pic_sign_data_hiding_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that sign bit hiding is enabled for the current picture. When pic_sign_data_hiding_enabled_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag equal to 1 specifies that deblocking parameters are present in the PH. ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag equal to 0 specifies that deblocking parameters are not present in the PH. When not present, the value of ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that the operation of the deblocking filter is not applied for the slices associated with the PH. ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the operation of the deblocking filter is applied for the slices associated with the PH. When ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag.

ph_beta_offset_div2 and ph_tc_offset_div2 specify the deblocking parameter offsets for β and tC (divided by 2) that are applied to the luma component for the slices associated with the PH. The values of ph_beta_offset_div2 and ph_tc_offset_div2 shall both be in the range of −12 to 12, inclusive. When not present, the values of ph_beta_offset_div2 and ph_tc_offset_div2 are inferred to be equal to pps_beta_offset_div2 and pps_tc_offset_div2, respectively.

ph_cb_beta_offset_div2 and ph_cb_tc_offset_div2 specify the deblocking parameter offsets for β and tC (divided by 2) that are applied to the Cb component for the slices associated with the PH. The values of ph_cb_beta_offset_div2 and ph_cb_tc_offset_div2 shall both be in the range of −12 to 12, inclusive. When not present, the values of ph_cb_beta_offset_div2 and ph_cb_tc_offset_div2 are inferred to be equal to pps_cb_beta_offset_div2 and pps_cb_tc_offset_div2, respectively.

ph_cr_beta_offset_div2 and ph_cr_tc_offset_div2 specify the deblocking parameter offsets for β and tC (divided by 2) that are applied to the Cr component for the slices associated with the PH. The values of ph_cr_beta_offset_div2 and ph_cr_tc_offset_div2 shall both be in the range of −12 to 12, inclusive. When not present, the values of ph_cr_beta_offset_div2 and ph_cr_tc_offset_div2 are inferred to be equal to pps_cr_beta_offset_div2 and pps_cr_tc_offset_div2, respectively.

ph_extension_length specifies the length of the PH extension data in bytes, not including the bits used for signalling ph_extension_length itself. The value of ph_extension_length shall be in the range of 0 to 256, inclusive. When not present, the value of ph_extension_length is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_extension_data_byte may have any value. Decoders conforming to this version of this Specification shall ignore the value of ph_extension_data_byte. Its value does not affect decoder conformance to profiles specified in this version of specification.

3.4. SH Syntax and Semantics

In the latest VVC draft text, the SH syntax and semantics are as follows:

Descriptor slice_header( ) {  picture_header_in_slice_header_flag u(1)  if( picture_header_in_slice_header_flag )   picture_header_structure( )  if( subpic_info_present_flag )   slice_subpic_id u(v)  if( ( rect_slice_flag && NumSlicesInSubpic[ CurrSubpicIdx ] > 1 ) | |    ( !rect_slice_flag && NumTilesInPic > 1 ) )   slice_address u(v)  for( i = 0; i < NumExtraShBits; i++ )   sh_extra_bit[ i ] u(1)  if( !rect_slice_flag && NumTilesInPic > 1 )   num_tiles_in_slice_minus1 ue(v)  if( ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag )   slice_type ue(v)  if( sps_alf_enabled_flag && !alf_info_in_ph_flag ) {   slice_alf_enabled_flag u(1)   if( slice_alf_enabled_flag ) {    slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma u(3)    for( i = 0; i < slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma; i++ )     slice_alf_aps_id_luma[ i ] u(3)    if( ChromaArrayType != 0 )     slice_alf_chroma_idc u(2)    if( slice_alf_chroma_idc )     slice_alf_aps_id_chroma u(3)    if( sps_ccalf_enabled_flag ) {     slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag u(1)     if( slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag )      slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id u(3)     slice_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag u(1)     if( slice_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag )      slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id u(3)    }   }  }  if( separate_colour_plane_flag = = 1 )   colour_plane_id u(2)  if( !rpl_info_in_ph_flag && ( ( nal_unit_type != IDR_W_RADL && nal_unit_type !=    IDR_N_LP ) | | sps_idr_rpl_present_flag ) )   ref_pic_lists( )  if( ( rpl_info_in_ph_flag | | ( ( nal_unit_type != IDR_W_RADL && nal_unit_type !=    IDR_N_LP ) | | sps_idr_rpl_present_flag ) ) &&    ( slice_type != I && num_ref_entries[ 0 ][ RplsIdx[ 0 ] ] > 1 ) | |    ( slice_type = = B && num_ref_entries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx[ 1 ] ] > 1 ) ) {   num_ref_idx_active_override_flag u(1)   if( num_ref_idx_active_override_flag )    for( i = 0; i < ( slice_type = = B ? 2: 1 ); i++ )     if( num_ref_entries[ i ][ RplsIdx[ i ] ] > 1 )      num_ref_idx_active_minus1[ i ] ue(v)  }  if( slice_type != I ) {   if( cabac_init_present_flag )    cabac_init_flag u(1)   if( ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag && !rpl_info_in_ph_flag ) {    if( slice_type = = B )     slice_collocated_from_l0_flag u(1)    if( ( slice_collocated_from_l0_flag && NumRefIdxActive[ 0 ] > 1 ) | | ( ! slice_collocated_from_l0_flag && NumRefIdxActive[ 1 ] > 1 ) )     slice_collocated_ref_idx ue(v)   }   if( !wp_info_in_ph_flag && ( ( pps_weighted_pred_flag && slice_type = = P ) | | ( pps_weighted_bipred_flag && slice_type = = B ) ) )    pred_weight_table( )  }  if( !qp_delta_info_in_ph_flag )   slice_qp_delta se(v)  if( pps_slice_chroma_qp_offsets_present_flag ) {   slice_cb_qp_offset se(v)   slice_cr_qp_offset se(v)   if( sps_joint_cbcr_enabled_flag )    slice_joint_cbcr_qp_offset se(v)  }  if( pps_cu_chroma_qp_offset_list_enabled_flag )   cu_chroma_qp_offset_enabled_flag u(1)  if( sps_sao_enabled_flag && !sao_info_in_ph_flag ) {   slice_sao_luma_flag u(1)   if( ChromaArrayType != 0 )    slice_sao_chroma_flag u(1)  }  if( deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag && !dbf_info_in_ph_flag )   slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag u(1)  if( slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag ) {   slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag u(1)   if( !slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag ) {    slice_beta_offset_div2 se(v)    slice_tc_offset_div2 se(v)    slice_cb_beta_offset_div2 se(v)    slice_cb_tc_offset_div2 se(v)    slice_cr_beta_offset_div2 se(v)    slice_cr_tc_offset_div2 se(v)   }  }  slice_ts_residual_coding_disabled_flag u(1)  if( ph_lmcs_enabled_flag )   slice_lmcs_enabled_flag u(1)  if( ph_scaling_list_enabled_flag )   slice_scaling_list_present_flag u(1)  if( NumEntryPoints > 0 ) {   offset_len_minus1 ue(v)   for( i = 0; i < NumEntryPoints; i++ )    entry_point_offset_minus1[ i ] u(v)  }  if( slice_header_extension_present_flag ) {   slice_header_extension_length ue(v)   for( i = 0; i < slice_header_extension_length; i++)    slice_header_extension_data_byte[ i ] u(8)  }  byte_alignment( ) }

The variable CuQpDeltaVal, specifying the difference between a luma quantization parameter for the coding unit containing cu_qp_delta_abs and its prediction, is set equal to 0. The variables CuQpOffset_(Cb), CuQpOffset_(Cr), and CuQpOffset_(CbCr), specifying values to be used when determining the respective values of the Qp′_(Cb), Qp′_(Cr), and Qp′_(CbCr) quantization parameters for the coding unit containing cu_chroma_qp_offset_flag, are all set equal to 0.

picture_header_in_slice_header_flag equal to 1 specifies that the PH syntax structure is present in the slice header. picture_header_in_slice_header_flag equal to 0 specifies that the PH syntax structure is not present in the slice header.

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the value of picture_header_in_slice_header_flag shall be the same in all coded slices in a CLVS.

When picture_header_in_slice_header_flag is equal to 1 for a coded slice, it is a requirement of bitstream conformance that no VCL NAL unit with nal_unit_type equal to PH_NUT shall be present in the CLVS.

When picture_header_in_slice_header_flag is equal to 0, all coded slices in the current picture shall have picture_header_in_slice_header_flag is equal to 0, and the current PU shall have a PH NAL unit.

slice_subpic_id specifies the subpicture ID of the subpicture that contains the slice. If slice_subpic_id is present, the value of the variable CurrSubpicIdx is derived to be such that SubpicIdVal[CurrSubpicIdx] is equal to slice_subpic_id. Otherwise (slice_subpic_id is not present), CurrSubpicIdx is derived to be equal to 0. The length of slice_subpic_id is sps_subpic_id_len_minus1+1 bits.

slice_address specifies the slice address of the slice. When not present, the value of slice_address is inferred to be equal to 0. When rect_slice_flag is equal to 1 and NumSlicesInSubpic[CurrSubpicIdx] is equal to 1, the value of slice_address is inferred to be equal to 0.

If rect_slice_flag is equal to 0, the following applies:

-   -   The slice address is the raster scan tile index.     -   The length of slice_address is Ceil(Log 2 (NumTilesInPic)) bits.     -   The value of slice_address shall be in the range of 0 to         NumTilesInPic−1, inclusive.

Otherwise (rect_slice_flag is equal to 1), the following applies:

-   -   The slice address is the subpicture-level slice index of the         slice.     -   The length of slice_address is Ceil(Log         2(NumSlicesInSubpic[CurrSubpicIdx])) bits.     -   The value of slice_address shall be in the range of 0 to         NumSlicesInSubpic[CurrSubpicIdx]−1, inclusive.

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the following constraints apply:

-   -   If rect_slice_flag is equal to 0 or subpic_info_present_flag is         equal to 0, the value of slice_address shall not be equal to the         value of slice_address of any other coded slice NAL unit of the         same coded picture.     -   Otherwise, the pair of slice_subpic_id and slice_address values         shall not be equal to the pair of slice_subpic_id and         slice_address values of any other coded slice NAL unit of the         same coded picture.     -   The shapes of the slices of a picture shall be such that each         CTU, when decoded, shall have its entire left boundary and         entire top boundary consisting of a picture boundary or         consisting of boundaries of previously decoded CTU(s).

sh_extra_bit[i] may be equal to 1 or 0. Decoders conforming to this version of this Specification shall ignore the value of sh_extra_bit[i]. Its value does not affect decoder conformance to profiles specified in this version of specification.

num_tiles_in_slice_minus1 plus 1, when present, specifies the number of tiles in the slice. The value of num_tiles_in_slice_minus1 shall be in the range of 0 to NumTilesInPic−1, inclusive.

The variable NumCtusInCurrSlice, which specifies the number of CTUs in the current slice, and the list CtbAddrInCurrSlice[i], for i ranging from 0 to NumCtusInCurrSlice−1, inclusive, specifying the picture raster scan address of the i-th CTB within the slice, are derived as follows:

if( rect_slice_flag ) {  picLevelSliceIdx = slice_address  for( j = 0; j < CurrSubpicIdx; j++ )   picLevelSliceIdx += NumSlicesInSubpic[ j ]  NumCtusInCurrSlice = NumCtusInSlice[ picLevelSliceIdx ]  for( i = 0; i < NumCtusInCurrSlice; i++ )   CtbAddrInCurrSlice[ i ] = CtbAddrInSlice[ picLevelSliceIdx ][ i ]   (117) } else {  NumCtusInCurrSlice = 0  for( tileIdx = slice_address; tileIdx <= slice_address + num_tiles_in_slice_minus1; tileIdx++ ) {   tileX = tileIdx % NumTileColumns   tileY = tileIdx / NumTileColumns   for( ctbY = tileRowBd[ tileY ]; ctbY < tileRowBd[ tileY + 1 ]; ctbY++ ) {    for( ctbX = tileColBd[ tileX ]; ctbX < tileColBd[ tileX + 1 ]; ctbX++ ) {     CtbAddrInCurrSlice[ NumCtusInCurrSlice ] = ctbY * PicWidthInCtb + ctbX     NumCtusInCurrSlice++    }   }  } }

The variables SubpicLeftBoundaryPos, SubpicTopBoundaryPos, SubpicRightBoundaryPos, and SubpicBotBoundaryPos are derived as follows:

if( subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[ CurrSubpicIdx ] ) {  SubpicLeftBoundaryPos = subpic_ctu_top_left_x[ CurrSubpicIdx ] * CtbSizeY  SubpicRightBoundaryPos = Min( pic_width_max_in_luma_samples − 1,   ( subpic_ctu_top_left_x[ CurrSubpicIdx ] +   subpic_width_minus1[ CurrSubpicIdx ] + 1 ) * CtbSizeY − 1 )  SubpicTopBoundaryPos = subpic_ctu_top_left_y[ CurrSubpicIdx ] *CtbSizeY (118)  SubpicBotBoundaryPos = Min( pic_height_max_in_luma_samples − 1,   ( subpic_ctu_top_left_y[ CurrSubpicIdx ] +   subpic_height_minus1[ CurrSubpicIdx ] + 1 ) * CtbSizeY − 1 ) }

slice_type specifies the coding type of the slice according to Table 9.

TABLE 9 Name association to slice_type slice_type Name of slice_type 0 B (B slice) 1 P (P slice) 2 I (I slice)

When not present, the value of slice_type is inferred to be equal to 2.

When ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag is equal to 0, the value of slice_type shall be equal to 0 or 1. When nal_unit_type is in the range of IDR_W_RADL to CRA_NUT, inclusive, and vps_independent_layer_flag[GeneralLayerIdx[nuh_layer_id]] is equal to 1, slice_type shall be equal to 2.

The variables MinQtLog 2SizeY, MinQtLog 2SizeC, MinQtSizeY, MinQtSizeC, MaxBtSizeY, MaxBtSizeC, MinBtSizeY, MaxTtSizeY, MaxTtSizeC, MinTtSizeY, MaxMttDepthY and MaxMttDepthC are derived as follows:

-   -   If slice_type equal to 2 (I), the following applies:

MinQtLog 2SizeY=MinCbLog 2SizeY+ph_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_intra_slice_luma  (119)

MinQtLog 2SizeC=MinCbLog 2SizeY+ph_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_intra_slice_chroma  (120)

MaxBtSizeY=1<<(MinQtLog 2SizeY+ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_intra_slice_luma)  (121)

MaxBtSizeC=1<<(MinQtLog 2SizeC+ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_intra_slice_chroma)  (122)

MaxTtSizeY=1<<(MinQtLog 2SizeY+ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_intra_slice_luma)  (123)

MaxTtSizeC=1<<(MinQtLog 2SizeC+ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_intra_slice_chroma)  (124)

MaxMttDepthY=ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_luma  (125)

MaxMttDepthC=ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_intra_slice_chroma  (126)

CuQpDeltaSubdiv=ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_intra_slice  (127)

CuChromaQpOffsetSubdiv=ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_intra_slice  (128)

-   -   Otherwise (slice_type equal to 0 (B) or 1 (P)), the following         applies:

MinQtLog 2SizeY=MinCbLog 2SizeY+ph_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_inter_slice  (129)

MinQtLog 2SizeC=MinCbLog 2SizeY+ph_log 2_diff_min_qt_min_cb_inter_slice  (130)

MaxBtSizeY=1<<(MinQtLog 2SizeY+ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_inter_slice)  (131)

MaxBtSizeC=1<<(MinQtLog 2SizeC+ph_log 2_diff_max_bt_min_qt_inter_slice)  (132)

MaxTtSizeY=1<<(MinQtLog 2SizeY+ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_inter_slice)  (133)

MaxTtSizeC=1<<(MinQtLog 2SizeC+ph_log 2_diff_max_tt_min_qt_inter_slice)  (134)

MaxMttDepthY=ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_inter_slice  (135)

MaxMttDepthC=ph_max_mtt_hierarchy_depth_inter_slice  (136)

CuQpDeltaSubdiv=ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_inter_slice  (137)

CuChromaQpOffsetSubdiv=ph_cu_chroma_qp_offset_subdiv_inter_slice  (138)

-   -   The following applies:

MinQtSizeY=1<<MinQtLog 2SizeY  (139)

MinQtSizeC=1<<MinQtLog 2SizeC  (140)

MinBtSizeY=1<<MinCbLog 2SizeY  (141)

MinTtSizeY=1<<MinCbLog 2SizeY  (142)

slice_alf_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that adaptive loop filter is enabled and may be applied to Y, Cb, or Cr colour component in a slice. slice_alf_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that adaptive loop filter is disabled for all colour components in a slice. When not present, the value of slice_alf_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to ph_alf_enabled_flag.

slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma specifies the number of ALF APSs that the slice refers to. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma is not present, the value of slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma.

slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is not present, the value of slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i].

The value of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be equal to 1.

slice_alf_chroma_idc equal to 0 specifies that the adaptive loop filter is not applied to Cb and Cr colour components. slice_alf_chroma_idc equal to 1 indicates that the adaptive loop filter is applied to the Cb colour component. slice_alf_chroma_idc equal to 2 indicates that the adaptive loop filter is applied to the Cr colour component. slice_alf_chroma_idc equal to 3 indicates that the adaptive loop filter is applied to Cb and Cr colour components. When slice_alf_chroma_idc is not present, it is inferred to be equal to ph_alf_chroma_idc.

slice_alf_aps_id_chroma specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the chroma component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_chroma shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is not present, the value of slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_chroma.

The value of alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_chroma shall be equal to 1.

slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the cross-component filter is not applied to the Cb colour component. slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag equal to 1 indicates that the cross-component filter is enabled and may be applied to the Cb colour component. When slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to ph_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag.

slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id that the Cb colour component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is not present, the value of slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id.

The value of alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be equal to 1.

slice_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the cross-component filter is not applied to the Cr colour component. slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag equal to 1 indicates that the cross-component adaptive loop filter is enabled and may be applied to the Cr colour component. When slice_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to ph_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag.

slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id that the Cr colour component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is not present, the value of slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id.

The value of alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be equal to 1.

colour_plane_id identifies the colour plane associated with the current slice when separate_colour_plane_flag is equal to 1. The value of colour_plane_id shall be in the range of 0 to 2, inclusive. colour_plane_id values 0, 1 and 2 correspond to the Y, Cb and Cr planes, respectively. The value 3 of colour_plane_id is reserved for future use by ITU-T|ISO/IEC.

-   -   NOTE 1—There is no dependency between the decoding processes of         different colour planes of one picture.

num_ref_idx_active_override_flag equal to 1 specifies that the syntax element num_ref_idx_active_minus1 [0] is present for P and B slices and the syntax element num_ref_idx_active_minus1 [1] is present for B slices. num_ref_idx_active_override_flag equal to 0 specifies that the syntax elements num_ref_idx_active_minus1[0] and num_ref_idx_active_minus1[1] are not present. When not present, the value of num_ref_idx_active_override_flag is inferred to be equal to 1.

num_ref_idx_active_minus1[i] is used for the derivation of the variable NumRefIdxActive[i] as specified by Equation 143. The value of num_ref_idx_active_minus1[i] shall be in the range of 0 to 14, inclusive.

For i equal to 0 or 1, when the current slice is a B slice, num_ref_idx_active_override_flag is equal to 1, and num_ref_idx_active_minus1[i] is not present, num_ref_idx_active_minus1[i] is inferred to be equal to 0.

When the current slice is a P slice, num_ref_idx_active_override_flag is equal to 1, and num_ref_idx_active_minus1[0] is not present, num_ref_idx_active_minus1[0] is inferred to be equal to 0.

The variable NumRefIdxActive[i] is derived as follows:

for( i = 0; i < 2; i++ ) {  if( slice_type = = B | | ( slice_type = = P && i = = 0 ) ) {   if( num_ref_idx_active_override_flag )    NumRefIdxActive[ i ] = num_ref_idx_active_minus1[ i ] + 1 (143)   else {    if( num_ref_entries[ i ][ RplsIdx[ i ] ] >= num_ref_idx_default_active_minus1[ i ] + 1 )     NumRefIdxActive[ i ] = num_ref_idx_default_active_minus1[ i ] + 1    else     NumRefIdxActive[ i ] = num_ref_entries[ i ][ RplsIdx[ i ] ]   }  } else /* slice_type = = I | | ( slice_type = = P && i = = 1 ) */   NumRefIdxActive[ i ] = 0 }

The value of NumRefIdxActive[i]−1 specifies the maximum reference index for reference picture list i that may be used to decode the slice. When the value of NumRefIdxActive[i] is equal to 0, no reference index for reference picture list i may be used to decode the slice.

When the current slice is a P slice, the value of NumRefIdxActive[0] shall be greater than 0.

When the current slice is a B slice, both NumRefIdxActive[0] and NumRefIdxActive[1] shall be greater than 0.

cabac_init_flag specifies the method for determining the initialization table used in the initialization process for context variables. When cabac_init_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

slice_collocated_from_l0_flag equal to 1 specifies that the collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference picture list 0. slice_collocated_from_l0_flag equal to 0 specifies that the collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference picture list 1.

When slice_type is equal to B or P, ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag is equal to 1, and slice_collocated_from_l0_flag is not present, the following applies:

-   -   If rpl_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 1,         slice_collocated_from_l0_flag is inferred to be equal to         ph_collocated_from_l0_flag.     -   Otherwise (rpl_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 0 and slice_type is         equal to P), the value of slice_collocated_from_l0_flag is         inferred to be equal to 1.

slice_collocated_ref_idx specifies the reference index of the collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction.

When slice_type is equal to P or when slice_type is equal to B and slice_collocated_from_l0_flag is equal to 1, slice_collocated_ref_idx refers to an entry in reference picture list 0, and the value of slice_collocated_ref_idx shall be in the range of 0 to NumRefIdxActive[0]−1, inclusive.

When slice_type is equal to B and slice_collocated_from_l0_flag is equal to 0, slice_collocated_ref_idx refers to an entry in reference picture list 1, and the value of slice_collocated_ref_idx shall be in the range of 0 to NumRefIdxActive[1]−1, inclusive.

When slice_collocated_ref_idx is not present, the following applies:

-   -   If rpl_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 1, the value of         slice_collocated_ref_idx is inferred to be equal to         ph_collocated_ref_idx.     -   Otherwise (rpl_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 0), the value of         slice_collocated_ref_idx is inferred to be equal to 0.

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the picture referred to by slice_collocated_ref_idx shall be the same for all slices of a coded picture.

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the values of pic_width_in_luma_samples and pic_height_in_luma_samples of the reference picture referred to by slice_collocated_ref_idx shall be equal to the values of pic_width_in_luma_samples and pic_height_in_luma_samples, respectively, of the current picture, and RprConstraintsActive[slice_collocated_from_l0_flag ? 0:1][slice_collocated_ref_idx] shall be equal to 0.

slice_qp_delta specifies the initial value of Qp_(Y) to be used for the coding blocks in the slice until modified by the value of CuQpDeltaVal in the coding unit layer.

When qp_delta_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 0, the initial value of the Qp_(Y) quantization parameter for the slice, SliceQp_(Y), is derived as follows:

SliceQp_(Y)=26+init_qp_minus26+slice_qp_delta  (144)

The value of SliceQp_(Y) shall be in the range of −QpBdOffset to +63, inclusive.

When either of the following conditions is true:

-   -   The value of wp_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 1,         pps_weighted_pred_flag is equal to 1, and slice_type is equal to         P.     -   The value of wp_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 1,         pps_weighted_bipred_flag is equal to 1, and slice_type is equal         to B.         the following applies:     -   The value of NumRefIdxActive[0] shall be less than or equal to         the value of NumWeightsL0.     -   For each reference picture index RefPicList[0][i] for i in the         range of 0 to NumRefIdxActive[0]−1, inclusive, the luma weight,         Cb weight, and Cr weight that apply to the reference picture         index are LumaWeightL0[i], ChromaWeightL0[0][i], and         ChromaWeightL0[1][i], respectively.

When wp_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 1, pps_weighted_bipred_flag is equal to 1, and slice_type is equal to B, the following applies:

-   -   The value of NumRefIdxActive[1] shall be less than or equal to         the value of NumWeightsL1.     -   For each reference picture index RefPicList[1][i] for i in the         range of 0 to NumRefIdxActive[1]−1, inclusive, the luma weight,         Cb weight, and Cr weight that apply to the reference picture         index are LumaWeightL1[i], ChromaWeightL1[0][i], and         ChromaWeightL1[1][i], respectively.

slice_cb_qp_offset specifies a difference to be added to the value of pps_cb_qp_offset when determining the value of the Qp′_(Cb) quantization parameter. The value of slice_cb_qp_offset shall be in the range of −12 to +12, inclusive. When slice_cb_qp_offset is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0. The value of pps_cb_qp_offset+slice_cb_qp_offset shall be in the range of −12 to +12, inclusive.

slice_cr_qp_offset specifies a difference to be added to the value of pps_cr_qp_offset when determining the value of the Qp′_(Cr) quantization parameter. The value of slice_cr_qp_offset shall be in the range of −12 to +12, inclusive. When slice_cr_qp_offset is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0. The value of pps_cr_qp_offset+slice_cr_qp_offset shall be in the range of −12 to +12, inclusive.

slice_joint_cber_qp_offset specifies a difference to be added to the value of pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_value when determining the value of the Qp′_(CbCr). The value of slice_joint_cbcr_qp_offset shall be in the range of −12 to +12, inclusive. When slice_joint_cbcr_qp_offset is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0. The value of pps_joint_cbcr_qp_offset_value+slice_joint_cbcr_qp_offset shall be in the range of −12 to +12, inclusive.

cu_chroma_qp_offset_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that the cu_chroma_qp_offset_flag may be present in the transform unit and palette coding syntax. cu_chroma_qp_offset_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the cu_chroma_qp_offset_flag is not present in the transform unit or palette coding syntax. When not present, the value of cu_chroma_qp_offset_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

slice_sao_luma_flag equal to 1 specifies that SAO is enabled for the luma component in the current slice; slice_sao_luma_flag equal to 0 specifies that SAO is disabled for the luma component in the current slice. When slice_sao_luma_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to ph_sao_luma_enabled_flag.

slice_sao_chroma_flag equal to 1 specifies that SAO is enabled for the chroma component in the current slice; slice_sao_chroma_flag equal to 0 specifies that SAO is disabled for the chroma component in the current slice. When slice_sao_chroma_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to ph_sao_chroma_enabled_flag.

slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag equal to 1 specifies that deblocking parameters are present in the slice header. slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag equal to 0 specifies that deblocking parameters are not present in the slice header. When not present, the value of slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag is inferred to be equal to ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag.

slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that the operation of the deblocking filter is not applied for the current slice. slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the operation of the deblocking filter is applied for the current slice. When slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag.

slice_beta_offset_div2 and slice_tc_offset_div2 specify the deblocking parameter offsets for β and tC (divided by 2) that are applied to the luma component for the current slice. The values of slice_beta_offset_div2 and slice_tc_offset_div2 shall both be in the range of −12 to 12, inclusive. When not present, the values of slice_beta_offset_div2 and slice_tc_offset_div2 are inferred to be equal to ph_beta_offset_div2 and ph_tc_offset_div2, respectively.

slice_cb_beta_offset_div2 and slice_cb_tc_offset_div2 specify the deblocking parameter offsets for β and tC (divided by 2) that are applied to the Cb component for the current slice. The values of slice_cb_beta_offset_div2 and slice_cb_tc_offset_div2 shall both be in the range of −12 to 12, inclusive. When not present, the values of slice_cb_beta_offset_div2 and slice_cb_tc_offset_div2 are inferred to be equal to ph_cb_beta_offset_div2 and ph_cb_tc_offset_div2, respectively.

slice_cb_beta_offset_div2 and slice_cb_tc_offset_div2 specify the deblocking parameter offsets for β and tC (divided by 2) that are applied to the Cr component for the current slice. The values of slice_cr_beta_offset_div2 and slice_cr_tc_offset_div2 shall both be in the range of −12 to 12, inclusive. When not present, the values of slice_cr_beta_offset_div2 and slice_cr_tc_offset_div2 are inferred to be equal to ph_cr_beta_offset_div2 and ph_cr_tc_offset_div2, respectively.

slice_ts_residual_coding_disabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that the residual_coding( ) syntax structure is used to parse the residual samples of a transform skip block for the current slice. slice_ts_residual_coding_disabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the residual_ts_coding( ) syntax structure is used to parse the residual samples of a transform skip block for the current slice. When slice_ts_residual_coding_disabled_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

slice_lmcs_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that luma mapping with chroma scaling is enabled for the current slice. slice_lmcs_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that luma mapping with chroma scaling is not enabled for the current slice. When slice_lmcs_enabled_flag is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

slice_scaling_list_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that the scaling list data used for the current slice is derived based on the scaling list data contained in the referenced scaling list APS with aps_params_type equal to SCALING_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_scaling_list_aps_id. slice_scaling_list_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that the scaling list data used for the current picture is the default scaling list data derived specified in clause 7.4.3.21. When not present, the value of slice_scaling_list_present_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

The variable NumEntryPoints, which specifies the number of entry points in the current slice, is derived as follows:

NumEntryPoints = 0 for( i = 1; i < NumCtusInCurrSlice; i++ ) {  ctbAddrX = CtbAddrInCurrSlice[ i ] % PicWidthInCtbsY  ctbAddrY = CtbAddrInCurrSlice[ i ] / PicWidthInCtbsY (145)  prevCtbAddrX = CtbAddrInCurrSlice[ i − 1 ] % PicWidthInCtbsY  prevCtbAddrY = CtbAddrInCurrSlice[ i − 1 ] / PicWidthInCtbsY  if( CtbToTileRowBd[ ctbAddrY ] != CtbToTileRowBd[ prevCtbAddrY ] | |   CtbToTileColBd[ ctbAddrX ] != CtbToTileColBd[ prevCtbAddrX ] | |   ( ctbAddrY != prevCtbAddrY && sps_wpp_entry_point_offsets_present_flag ) )  NumEntryPoints++ }

offset_len_minus1 plus 1 specifies the length, in bits, of the entry_point_offset_minus1[i] syntax elements. The value of offset_len_minus1 shall be in the range of 0 to 31, inclusive.

entry_point_offset_minus1[i] plus 1 specifies the i-th entry point offset in bytes, and is represented by offset_len_minus1 plus 1 bits. The slice data that follow the slice header consists of NumEntryPoints+1 subsets, with subset index values ranging from 0 to NumEntryPoints, inclusive. The first byte of the slice data is considered byte 0.

When present, emulation prevention bytes that appear in the slice data portion of the coded slice NAL unit are counted as part of the slice data for purposes of subset identification. Subset 0 consists of bytes 0 to entry_point_offset_minus1[0], inclusive, of the coded slice data, subset k, with k in the range of 1 to NumEntryPoints−1, inclusive, consists of bytes firstByte[k] to lastByte[k], inclusive, of the coded slice data with firstByte[k] and lastByte[k] defined as:

firstByte[k]=Σ _(n=1) ^(k)(entry_point_offset_minus1[n−1]+1)  (146)

lastByte[k]=firstByte[k]+entry_point_offset_minus1[k]  (147)

The last subset (with subset index equal to NumEntryPoints) consists of the remaining bytes of the coded slice data.

When sps_entropy_coding_sync_enabled_flag is equal to 0 and the slice contains one or more complete tiles, each subset shall consist of all coded bits of all CTUs in the slice that are within the same tile, and the number of subsets (i.e., the value of NumEntryPoints+1) shall be equal to the number of tiles in the slice.

When sps_entropy_coding_sync_enabled_flag is equal to 0 and the slice contains a subset of CTU rows from a single tile, the NumEntryPoints shall be 0, and the number of subsets shall be 1. The subset shall consist of all coded bits of all CTUs in the slice.

When sps_entropy_coding_sync_enabled_flag is equal to 1, each subset k with k in the range of 0 to NumEntryPoints, inclusive, shall consist of all coded bits of all CTUs in a CTU row within a tile, and the number of subsets (i.e., the value of NumEntryPoints+1) shall be equal to the total number of tile-specific CTU rows in the slice.

slice_header_extension_length specifies the length of the slice header extension data in bytes, not including the bits used for signalling slice_header_extension_length itself. The value of slice_header_extension_length shall be in the range of 0 to 256, inclusive. When not present, the value of slice_header_extension_length is inferred to be equal to 0.

slice_header_extension_data_byte[i] may have any value. Decoders conforming to this version of this Specification shall ignore the values of all the slice_header_extension_data_byte[i] syntax elements. Its value does not affect decoder conformance to profiles specified in this version of specification.

3.5. Chroma QP Mapping Table

In clause 7.3.2.3 of JVET-Q2001-vC, the SPS includes a structure named chroma QP table shown as follows:

Descriptor seq_parameter_set_rbsp( ) {  . . . . . .  if( ChromaArrayType != 0 ) {   sps_joint_cbcr_enabled_flag u(1)   same_qp_table_for_chroma u(1)   numQpTables = same_qp_table_for_chroma ? 1 : ( sps_joint_cbcr_enabled_flag ? 3 : 2 )   for( i = 0; i < numQpTables; i++ ) {    qp_table_start_minus26[ i ] se(v)    num_points_in_qp_table_minus1[ i ] ue(v)    for( j = 0; j <= num_points_in_qp_table_minus1[ i ]; j++ ) {     delta_qp_in_val_minus1[ i ][ j ] ue(v)     delta_qp_diff_val[ i ][ j ] ue(v)    }   }  }  . . . . .

They are with the following semantics and QP table derivation:

sps_joint_cbcr_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the joint coding of chroma residuals is disabled. sps_joint_cbcr_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that the joint coding of chroma residuals is enabled. When not present, the value of sps_joint_cbcr_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

same_qp_table_for_chroma equal to 1 specifies that only one chroma QP mapping table is signalled and this table applies to Cb and Cr residuals and additionally to joint Cb-Cr residuals when sps_joint_cbcr_enabled_flag is equal to 1. same_qp_table_for_chroma equal to 0 specifies that chroma QP mapping tables, two for Cb and Cr, and one additional for joint Cb-Cr when sps_joint_cbcr_enabled_flag is equal to 1, are signalled in the SPS. When same_qp_table_for_chroma is not present in the bitstream, the value of same_qp_table_for_chroma is inferred to be equal to 1.

qp_table_start_minus26[i] plus 26 specifies the starting luma and chroma QP used to describe the i-th chroma QP mapping table. The value of qp_table_start_minus26[i] shall be in the range of −26−QpBdOffset to 36 inclusive.

When qp_table_start_minus26[i] is not present in the bitstream, the value of qp_table_start_minus26[i] is inferred to be equal to 0.

num_points_in_qp_table_minus1 [i] plus 1 specifies the number of points used to describe the i-th chroma QP mapping table. The value of num_points_in_qp_table_minus11[i] shall be in the range of 0 to 63+QpBdOffset, inclusive. When num_points_in_qp_table_minus1[0] is not present in the bitstream, the value of num_points_in_qp_table_minus1[0] is inferred to be equal to 0.

delta_qp_in_val_minus1[i][j] specifies a delta value used to derive the input coordinate of the j-th pivot point of the i-th chroma QP mapping table. When delta_qp_in_val_minus1[0][j] is not present in the bitstream, the value of delta_qp_in_val_minus1[0][j] is inferred to be equal to 0.

delta_qp_diff_val[i][j] specifies a delta value used to derive the output coordinate of the j-th pivot point of the i-th chroma QP mapping table.

The i-th chroma QP mapping table ChromaQPTable [ i ] for i = 0..numQPTables − 1 is derived as follows qpInVal[ i ][ 0 ] = qp_table_start_minus26[ i ] + 26 qpOutVal[ i ][ 0 ] = qpInVal[ i ][ 0 ] for( j = 0; j <= num_points_in_qp_table_minus1[ i ]; j++ ) {  qpInVal[ i ][ j + 1 ] = qpInVal[ i ][ j ] +  delta_qp_in_val_minus1[ i ][ j ] + 1  qpOutVal[ i ][ j + 1 ] = qpOutVal[ i ][ j ] + ( delta_qp_in_val_minus1[ i ][ j ] {circumflex over ( )} delta_qp_diff_val[ i ][ j ] ) } ChromaQpTable[ i ][ qpInVal[ i ][ 0 ] ] = qpOutVal[ i ][ 0 ] for( k = qpInVal[ i ][ 0 ] − 1; k >= −QpBdOffset; k − − )  ChromaQpTable[ i ][ k ] = Clip3( −QpBdOffset, 63,  ChromaQpTable[ i ][ k + 1 ] − 1 ) for( j = 0; j <= num_points_in_qp_table_minus1[ i ]; j++ ) {  sh = (delta_qp_in_val_minus1[ i ][j ] + 1 ) >> 1  for( k = qpInVal[ i ][ j ] + 1, m = 1; k <= qpInval[ i ][ j + l ]; k++,  m++ )   ChromaQpTable[ i ][ k ] = ChromaQpTable[ i ][ qpInVal[ i ][ j ] ] +    ( ( qpOutVal[ i ][ j + 1] − qpOutVal[ i ][j ] ) * m + sh ) / ( delta_qp_in_val_minus1[ i ][j] + 1 ) } for( k = qpInVal[ i ][ num_points_in_qp_table_minus1[ i ] + 1 ] + 1; k <= 63; k++ )  ChromaQpTable[ i ][ k ] = Clip3( −QpBdOffset, 63, ChromaQpTable[ i ][ k − 1 ] + 1 )

When same_qp_table_for_chroma is equal to 1, ChromaQpTable[1][k] and ChromaQpTable[2][k] are set equal to ChromaQpTable[0][k] for k in the range of −QpBdOffset to 63, inclusive.

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the values of qpInVal[i][j] and qpOutVal[i][j] shall be in the range of −QpBdOffset to 63, inclusive for i in the range of 0 to numQpTables−1, inclusive, and j in the range of 0 to num_points_in_qp_table_minus1[i]+1, inclusive.

In the above description, QpBdOffset is derived as:

bit_depth_minus8 specifies the bit depth of the samples of the luma and chroma arrays, BitDepth, and the value of the luma and chroma quantization parameter range offset, QpBdOffset, as follows:

BitDepth=8+bit_depth_minus8

QpBdOffset=6*bit_depth_minus8

bit_depth_minus8 shall be in the range of 0 to 8, inclusive.

4. TECHNICAL PROBLEMS SOLVED BY DISCLOSED TECHNICAL SOLUTIONS

The existing designs in the latest VVC draft specification for APS, deblocking, subpicture, and QP delta have the following problems:

-   -   1) Currently, the value of the APS syntax element         scaling_list_chroma_present_flag is constrained based on         ChromaArrayType derived from SPS syntax elements         chroma_format_idc and separate_colour_plane_flag, phrased as         follows: scaling_list_chroma_present_flag shall be equal to 0         when ChromaArrayType is equal to 0, and shall be equal to 1 when         ChromaArrayType is not equal to 0.         -   Such constraints in the semantics of the APS syntax element             introduce semantics dependencies of APS on SPS, which should             not occur, because since there is no PPS ID or SPS ID in the             APS syntax, an APS may be applied to pictures (or slices of             pictures) that refer to different SPSs, which may be             associated with different values of ChromaArrayType.             -   a. Additionally, similar APS-SPS semantics dependencies                 also exist in the semantics of some ALF/CC-ALF APS                 syntax elements, phrased as follows:                 alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag,                 alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag, and                 alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag shall to be equal to 0 when                 ChromaArrayType is equal to 0.             -   b. Currently, when an LMCS APS is signalled, the chroma                 residual scaling related syntax elements are always                 signalled in the LMCS APS syntax structure, regardless                 of whether ChromaArrayType is equal to 0 (i.e., there is                 no chroma component in the CLVS). This results in                 unnecessary signalling of chroma-related syntax                 elements.     -   2) It is asserted that the deblocking control mechanism in the         latest VVC text is pretty complicated, not straightforward, and         not easy to understand, and consequently prone to errors. Here         are some example issues we observed:         -   a. According to the current text, even if the deblocking             filter is disabled in the PPS, it can be enabled in the PH             or SH. For example, if pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag             is firstly signalled to be equal to 1, and             deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag is also signalled to             be equal to 1, it indicates that the deblocking filter is             disabled at PPS and it also allows the deblocking filter             enable/disable control being overridden in the PH or SH.             Then dbf_info_in_ph_flag is signalled subsequently and the             PH syntax element ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag might             be signalled to be equal to 0 which ultimately enables the             deblocking filter for slices associated with the PH. In such             case, the deblocking is eventually enabled at PH regardless             that it has been disabled at the higher level (e.g., PPS).             Such design logic is unique in VVC text, and it is quite             different from the design logic of other coding tools (e.g.,             ALF, SAO, LMCS, TMVP, WP, and etc.) as normally when a             coding tool is disabled at a higher layer (e.g., SPS, PPS),             then it is disabled completely at lower layers (e.g., PH,             SH).         -   b. Furthermore, the current definition of             pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is like             “pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag equal to 1 specifies             that the operation of deblocking filter is not applied for             slices referring to the PPS in which             slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not present . . .             ”. However, according to the current syntax table, even             though pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is equal to 1 and             slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not present, the             operation of deblocking filter would still be applied in             case of ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is present and             signalled to be equal to 0. Therefore, the current             definition of pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not             correct.         -   c. Moreover, according to the current text, if both the PPS             syntax elements deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag and             pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag are equal to 1, it             specifies that deblocking is disabled in PPS and the control             of deblocking filter is intended to be overridden in the PH             or SH. However, the subsequent PH syntax elements             ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag and             ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag might be still signalled             to be equal to 1, which turns out that the resulted             overriding process doesn't change anything (e.g., deblocking             remains disabled in the PH/SH) but just use unnecessary bits             for meaningless signalling.         -   d. In addition, according to the current text, when the SH             syntax element slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag is not             present, it is inferred to be equal to             ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag. However, besides             implicit or explicit signalling in the PPS, the deblocking             parameters can only be signalled either in PH or SH             according to dbf_info_in_ph_flag, but never both. Therefore,             when dbf_info_in_ph_flag is true, the intention is to allow             to signal the overriding deblocking filter parameters in the             PH. In this case, if the PH override flag is true and the SH             override flag is not signalled but inferred to be equal to             the PH override flag, additional deblocking filter             parameters will still be signalled in the SH which is             conflicting with the intention.         -   e. In addition, there is no SPS-level deblocking on/off             control, which may be added and the related syntax elements             in PPS/PH/SH may be updated accordingly.     -   3) Currently, when the PPS syntax element         single_slice_per_subpic_flag is not present, it is inferred to         be equal to 0. single_slice_per_subpic_flag is not present in         two cases: i) no_pic_partition_flag is equal to 1, and ii)         no_pic_partition_flag is equal to 0 and rect_slice_flag is equal         to 0.         -   For case i), no_pic_partition_flag equal to 1 specifies that             no picture partitioning is applied to each picture referring             to the PPS, therefore, there is only one slice in each             picture, and consequently, there is only one subpicture in             each picture and there is only one slice in each subpicture.             Therefore, in this case single_slice_per_subpic_flag should             be inferred to be equal 1.         -   For case ii), since rect_slice_flag is equal to 0, an             inferred value of single_slice_per_subpic_flag is not             needed.     -   4) Currently, luma qp delta in either picture or slice level is         always signalled mandatorily, either in the PH or SH, never         both. Whereas the slice-level chroma QP offset is optionally         signalled in the SH. Such design is somewhat not consistent.         -   a. Additionally, the current semantics of the PPS syntax             element cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag is worded as follows:             cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that the             ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_intra_slice and             ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_inter_slice syntax elements are             present in PHs referring to the PPS and cu_qp_delta_abs may             be present in the transform unit syntax . . . . However,             cu_qp_delta_abs may be also present in the palette coding             syntax, which should also be specified by             cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag. In other words, the current             semantics of cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag is not clear enough             and a bit confusing.     -   5) The current design of chroma Qp mapping table is not         straightforward to represent the case of chroma Qp equal to luma         Qp.     -   6) Currently, the subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is inferred to         be equal to the value of sps_independent_subpics_flag. However,         the current spec only allows the horizontal wrap-around to be         enabled when subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is equal to 0,         wherein the wrap-around motion compensation is designed for 360         video content. Therefore, when a pictures contains only one         subpicture (especially for the case that a complete 360 video         sequence contains only one subpicture), the inferred value for         subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] may be inferred to be equal to 0         or a certain value that allows the wrap-around motion         compensation.     -   7) Currently, the semantics of         pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not correct and         incomplete. e.g., when pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is         equal to 1, deblocking may be enabled or disabled for slices         referring to this PPS, but those conditions are not mentioned in         the semantics. Similarly for the part of semantics for         pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is equal to 0.         -   a. Furthermore, when the PPS syntax element             pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag are equal to 1, and             meanwhile the PH/SH syntax element             ph/slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag is signalled to be             equal to 1, the ph/slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is             still allowed to be explicitly signalled to be equal to 1.             What this combination of values of the flags does is that             deblocking is said at the PPS level to be disabled and             allowed to be overridden at the picture or slice, then it is             indicated at the PH/SH level that it is going to be             overridden, and then a bit is signalled in the same header             (PH/SH) to finally determine that it is actually not             overridden and deblocking remains disabled at the             picture/slice level. This is asserted to have a double             undesirable effects: not only a bit is spent unnecessarily,             it is spent just for causing some confusion. We therefore             propose to further improve the semantics of deblocking             control syntax elements and remove the feature of allowing             indicating overriding and then immediately send the next bit             in the same PH or SH to indicate a change of mind.     -   8) The first coded slice of an IRAP or GDR picture in decoding         order may refer to a suffix APS NAL unit, which may delay the         random access reaction.     -   9) In VVC, it is disallowed to update the content of an APS NAL         unit within a PU, which may restrict some applications.     -   10) It is observed there are some issues/bugs in the current VVC         draft text (e.g., related to APS syntax), which should be fixed.         -   a. The absolute value of ALF filter coefficient (i.e.,             alf_luma_coeff_abs and alf_chroma_coeff_abs[altIdx][j] in             the VVC text) is in the range of [0, 128]. Therefore, 9 bits             are required to store the coefficient which just for the             storing the 128 and −128 values.     -   11) In the current text, the total number of allowed ALF APSs is         restricted to be 8 and each ALF APS takes about 512 bytes, so 8         of them take 4k bytes. Given the substantial memory impact, it         was suggested to consider a constraint on the total memory used         (or the number of filters in the APSs—there are up to 25 luma         and 8 chroma filters in one APS) rather than the number of APSs,         since the amount of memory used by an APS depends on its         content.     -   12) Currently, the APS ID (i.e., the syntax element         adaptation_parameter_set_id) is coded as u(5), while when         aps_params_type is equal to ALF_APS or SCALING_APS, the value of         adaptation_parameter_set_id shall be in the range of 0 to 7,         inclusive, and when aps_params_type is equal to LMCS_APS, the         value of adaptation_parameter_set_id shall be in the range of 0         to 3, inclusive. In other words, using 3 bits instead of 5 bits         for the APS ID would be sufficient.     -   13) Currently, the general constraint flags in the         general_constraint_info( ) syntax structure are parsed with         different orders. Grouped as inter-related and intra-related         syntax elements would be more structured.     -   14) The indication of allowed slice types (e.g.,         ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag) within a picture is always         signalled when inter slice is allowed for a picture. However, if         a picture only contains one slice, there is no need to further         signal the allowed intra slice flag if inter slice is allowed.

5. EXAMPLE EMBODIMENTS AND SOLUTIONS

To solve the above problems and some other problems not mentioned, methods as summarized below are disclosed. The embodiments should be considered as examples to explain the general concepts and should not be interpreted in a narrow way. Furthermore, these inventions can be applied individually or combined in any manner.

In the following discussion, an SH may be associated with a PH, i.e., the SH is associated with a slice, which is in the picture associated with the PH. An SH may be associated with a PPS, i.e., the SH is associated with a slice, which is in the picture associated with the PPS. A PH may be associated with a PPS, i.e., the PH is associated with a picture, which is associated with the PPS.

In the following discussion, a SPS may be associated with a PPS, i.e., the PPS may refer to the SPS.

In the following discussion, the changed texts are based on the latest VVC text in JVET-Q2001-vE. Most relevant parts that have been added or modified in boldface italics, and some of the deleted parts are marked with double brackets (e.g., [[a]] denotes the deletion of the character “a”).

-   -   1. Regarding the constraints on APS syntax elements for solving         the first problem, one or more of the following approaches are         disclosed:         -   a. In one example, constrain the value of             scaling_list_chroma_present_flag according to             ChromaArrayType derived by the PH syntax element.             -   i. For example, whether the value of                 scaling_list_chroma_present_flag is constrained or not                 may be dependent on whether ph_scaling_list_aps_id is                 present or not, e.g., as in the first set of                 embodiments.                 -   1) In one example, it is required that, when                     ph_scaling_list_aps_id is present, the value of                     scaling_list_chroma_present_flag of the APS NAL unit                     having aps_params_type equal to SCALING_APS and                     adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to                     ph_scaling_list_aps_id shall be equal to                     ChromaArrayType==0 ? 0:1.             -   ii. Alternatively, scaling_list_chroma_present_flag is                 constrained based on ChromaArrayType derived by the PH                 syntax elements, but regardless of the presence of                 ph_scaling_list_aps_id, e.g., as in the first set of                 embodiments.                 -   1) In one example, it is required that, the value of                     scaling_list_chroma_present_flag of the APS NAL unit                     having aps_params_type equal to SCALING_APS shall be                     equal to ChromaArrayType==0?0:1.         -   b. In one example, constrain the value of lmcs_delta_abs_crs             according to ChromaArrayType derived by the PH syntax             element.             -   i. For example, whether the value of lmcs_delta_abs_crs                 is constrained or not may be dependent on whether                 ph_lmcs_aps_id is present or not, e.g., as in the first                 set of embodiments.                 -   1) For example, it is required that, when                     ph_lmcs_aps_id is present, the value of                     lmcs_delta_abs_crs of the APS NAL unit having                     aps_params_type equal to LMCS_APS and                     adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_lmcs_aps_id                     shall be equal to 0 if ChromaArrayType is equal to 0                     and shall be greater than 0 otherwise.                 -   2) Alternatively, it is required that, when                     ph_lmcs_aps_id is present, the value of                     lmcs_delta_abs_crs of the APS NAL unit having                     aps_params_type equal to LMCS_APS and                     adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_lmcs_aps_id                     shall be equal to 0 if ChromaArrayType is equal to                     0.             -   ii. Alternatively, lmcs_delta_abs_crs is constrained                 based on ChromaArrayType derived by the PH syntax                 elements, but regardless of the presence of                 ph_lmcs_aps_id, e.g., as in the first set of                 embodiments.                 -   1) For example, it is required that, the value of                     lmcs_delta_abs_crs of the APS NAL unit equal to                     ph_lmcs_aps_id shall be equal to 0 if                     ChromaArrayType is equal to 0 and shall be greater                     than 0 otherwise.                 -   2) For example, it is required that, the value of                     lmcs_delta_abs_crs of the APS NAL unit equal to                     ph_lmcs_aps_id shall be equal to 0 if                     ChromaArrayType is equal to 0.         -   c. In one example, constrain the value of ALF APS syntax             elements (e.g., alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag,             alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag, alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag,             and etc.) according to ChromaArrayType derived by the PH             syntax elements and/or the SH syntax elements.             -   i. For example, whether the value of                 alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag and/or                 alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag and/or                 alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag are constrained or not may                 be dependent on whether ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] or                 slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is present or not and/or                 whether ChromaArrayType is equal to 0 or not, e.g., as                 in the first set of embodiments.                 -   1) For example, it is required that, when                     ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is present and ChromaArrayType                     is equal to 0, the values of                     alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag,                     alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag, and                     alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit                     having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and                     adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to                     ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall all be equal to 0.                 -   2) Additionally, it is required that, when                     slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is present and                     ChromaArrayType is equal to 0, the values of                     alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag,                     alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag, and                     alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit                     having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and                     adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to                     slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall all be equal to 0.             -   ii. Alternatively, alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag and/or                 alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag and/or                 alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag are constrained based on                 ChromaArrayType derived by the PH syntax elements or SH                 syntax elements, but regardless of the presence of                 ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] and/or slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i],                 e.g., as in the first set of embodiments.                 -   1) For example, it is required that, when                     ChromaArrayType is equal to 0, the values of                     alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag,                     alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag, and                     alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit                     having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS shall all be                     equal to 0.                 -   2) Additionally, it is required that, when                     ChromaArrayType is equal to 0, the values of                     alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag,                     alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag, and                     alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit                     having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS shall all be                     equal to 0.             -   iii. Alternatively, alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag and/or                 alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag and/or                 alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag are constrained based on                 ChromaArrayType derived by the chroma APS ID related PH                 or SH syntax elements, e.g., as in the first set of                 embodiments.                 -   1) For example, alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag is                     constrained according to ChromaArrayType derived by                     the PH syntax element ph_alf_aps_id_chroma and/or                     the SH syntax element slice_alf_aps_id_chroma.                 -   2) For example, alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag is                     constrained according to ChromaArrayType derived by                     the PH syntax element ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id and/or the                     SH syntax element slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id.                 -   3) For example, alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag is                     constrained according to ChromaArrayType derived by                     the PH syntax element ph_cr_alf_cb_aps_id and/or the                     SH syntax element slice_cr_alf_cb_aps_id.         -   d. In one example, the semantics of APS syntax elements in             the ALF and/or SCALING LIST and/or LMCS data syntax             structure may be not dependent on whether it is 4:0:0 video             coding and/or separate color plane coding.             -   i. For example, the semantics of APS syntax elements in                 the ALF data syntax structure (e.g.,                 alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag,                 alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag,                 alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag, and etc.) may be not                 dependent on variables/syntaxes derived by SPS/PH/SH                 syntax elements (e.g., ChromaArrayType), e.g., as in the                 first set of embodiments.             -   ii. Additionally, alternatively, the semantics of APS                 syntax elements in the SCALING LIST data syntax                 structure (e.g., scaling_list_chroma_present_flag, and                 etc.) may be not dependent on variables/syntaxes derived                 by SPS/PH/SH syntax elements (e.g., ChromaArrayType),                 e.g., as in the first set of embodiments.         -   e. Additionally, whether the temporalId of the             ALF/SCALING/LMCS APS NAL unit is constrained or not may be             dependent on whether the corresponding APS ID is present or             not, e.g., as in the first set of embodiments.             -   i. For example, whether the temporalId of the ALF APS                 NAL unit is constrained or not may be dependent on                 whether ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] and/or                 ph_alf_aps_id_chroma and/or ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id and/or                 ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is present or not.             -   ii. For example, whether the temporalId of the LMCS APS                 NAL unit is constrained or not may be dependent on                 whether ph_lmcs_aps_id is present or not.             -   iii. For example, whether the temporalId of the SCALING                 APS NAL unit is constrained or not may be dependent on                 whether ph_scaling_list_aps_id is present or not.         -   f. Additionally, whether the values of             alf_luma_filter_signal_flag, alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag             and/or alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag and/or             alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag shall be equal to 1 may be             dependent on whether the corresponding APS ID is present or             not, e.g., as in the first set of embodiments.             -   i. For example, whether alf_luma_filter_signal_flag                 shall be equal to 1 or not may be dependent on whether                 ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] and/or slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is                 present or not.             -   ii. For example, whether alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag                 shall be equal to 1 or not may be dependent on whether                 ph_alf_aps_id_chroma and/or slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is                 present or not.             -   iii. For example, whether alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag                 shall be equal to 1 or not may be dependent on whether                 ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id and/or slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is                 present or not.             -   iv. For example, whether alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag                 shall be equal to 1 or not may be dependent on whether                 ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id and/or slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is                 present or not.         -   g. Additionally, alternatively, whether the chroma ALF APS             ID syntax elements in the SH (e.g., slice_alf_aps_id_chroma,             slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id, slice_cr_alf_cb_aps_id, and etc.) in             inferred or not may be dependent on the value of             ChromaArrayType, e.g., as in the first set of embodiments.             -   i. For example, when ChromaArrayType is not equal to 0,                 the value of the chroma ALF APS ID syntax elements in                 the SH (e.g., slice_alf_aps_id_chroma,                 slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id, slice_cr_alf_cb_aps_id, and                 etc.) may be inferred.         -   h. In one example, the constraint of APS syntax elements             based on ChromaArrayType may be derived by the PH or SH             syntax elements.             -   i. Alternatively, the constraints of one or multiple                 syntax elements in an APS, such as indications of chroma                 information presence (e.g., whether chroma filters are                 signalled, chroma scaling list are signalled, LMCS                 residual scaling factor is equal to 0), may be defined                 in the semantics of PH and/or SH syntax elements.                 -   a) Alternatively, furthermore, the PH and/or SH                     syntax elements may refer to an APS.                 -   b) Alternatively, furthermore, the constraints of a                     same syntax element in different APS types may be                     different, i.e., using one-way (e.g., when certain                     condition is true, a constrain is applied) or                     two-way constraints (e.g., if certain condition is                     true, a first constrain is applied; otherwise, a                     second constrain is applied).             -   ii. In one example, the APS in which syntax elements are                 constrained is determined by an index (such as                 ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma, ph_alf_aps_id_chroma,                 ph_lmcs_aps_id and ph_scaling_list_aps_id) signaled in                 PH or SH.             -   iii. In one example, ChromaArrayType may be derived by                 information (such as chroma_format_idc and                 separate_colour_plane_flag) signaled in a SPS, which is                 determined by an index (such as                 pps_seq_parameter_set_id) signaled in a PPS, which is                 further determined by an index (such as                 ph_pic_parameter_set_id) signaled in the PH or SH.             -   iv. In one example, the constraints should be checked                 after parsing the APS and the PH or SH.             -   v. In one example, a syntax element (e.g., named                 aps_chroma_present_flag) may be signalled in the APS                 syntax structure (e.g., adaptation_parameter_set_rbsp(                 )) specifying whether the chroma-related APS syntax                 elements would be signalled or not                 -   a) In one example, the syntax element may be defined                     as that in the sixth embodiment.                 -   b) Alternatively, the syntax element (e.g., named                     aps_chroma_present_flag) may be used to control the                     presence of other syntax elements in the APS and/or                     how to signal the other syntax elements and/or how                     to derive the inferred values of the other syntax                     elements.                 -   c) For example, aps_chroma_present_flag equal to a                     certain value (such as 1) specifies that                     chroma-related APS syntax elements may be present in                     the LMCS/SCALING/ALF APS data.                 -   d) For example, aps_chroma_present_flag equal to a                     certain value (such as 0) specifies that                     chroma-related APS syntax element is not present in                     the LMCS/SCALING/ALF APS data.                 -   e) For example, aps_chroma_params_present_flag equal                     to 1 specifies that the APS NAL unit may include                     chroma information. aps_chroma_params_present_flag                     equal to 0 specifies that the APS NAL unit does not                     include chroma information.                 -   f) For example, when aps_chroma_present_flag is                     equal to a certain value (such as 0 or 1), the                     chroma-related APS syntax elements in the ALF APS                     syntax structure (e.g.,                     alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag,                     alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag, and                     alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag in the alf_data( )) may                     be not signalled.                 -   g) For example, when aps_chroma_present_flag is                     equal to a certain value (such as 0 or 1), the                     chroma-related APS syntax elements in the LMCS APS                     syntax structure (e.g., lmcs_delta_abs_crs and/or                     lmcs_delta_sign_crs_flag in the lmcs_data( )) may be                     not signalled.                 -   h) For example, when aps_chroma_present_flag is                     equal to a certain value (such as 0 or 1), the                     chroma-related APS syntax elements in the SCALING                     APS syntax structure (e.g.,                     scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[id],                     scaling_list_pred_id_delta[id],                     scaling_list_dc_coef[id−14],                     scaling_list_delta_coef[id][i] in the scaling_data(                     )) may be not signalled, wherein id is a number.                 -    a. For example, id is equal to some values in the                     range of 0 to X, inclusive (such as X=27).                 -    b. For example, id is not equal to X (such as                     X=27).                 -    c. For example, id % M is not equal to N (such as                     M=3, N=2).                 -   i) For example, when a chroma-related APS syntax                     element is not present, it is inferred to be equal                     to a certain value (such as 0 or 1).             -   vi. In one example, when the chroma-related APS syntax                 elements are allowed to be present (e.g.,                 aps_chroma_present_flag is equal to 1), it is required                 that at least one of alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag,                 alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag, and                 alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag shall be equal to 1.             -   vii. Alternatively, when the chroma-related APS syntax                 elements are allowed to be present (e.g.,                 aps_chroma_present_flag is equal to 1), the signalling                 of the syntax element X may be dependent on the values                 of the syntax elements in the set of Y.                 -   a) For example, X is alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag,                     and Y includes alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag and                     alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag.                 -   b) For example, X is alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag,                     and Y includes alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag and                     alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag.                 -   c) For example, X is alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag,                     and Y includes alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag and                     alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag.                 -   d) For example, when the values of the elements in Y                     are equal to 0, then the signalling of A is skipped.                 -   e) For example, the value of X is inferred to be                     equal to a certain value (such as 0 or 1) when not                     present.                 -   f) For example, the value of X is inferred to be                     equal to whether the chroma-related APS syntax                     element are allowed to be present (e.g., set to the                     value of aps_chroma_present_flag).             -   viii. Additionally, the syntax element                 aps_chroma_present_flag may be constrained by                 ChromaArrayType.                 -   a) For example, aps_chroma_present_flag shall be                     equal to 0 if ChromaArrayType is equal to 0.                 -   b) For example, aps_chroma_present_flag shall be                     equal to 1 if ChromaArrayType is larger than 0.             -   ix. Additionally, the constraint based on                 ChromaArrayType may be derived by the PH or SH syntax                 elements                 -   a) In one example, the constraint based on                     ChromaArrayType may be defined as that in the sixth                     embodiment.                 -   b) For example, the syntax element                     aps_chroma_present_flag may be constrained depending                     on ChromaArrayType and the type of the APSs (such as                     ALF APS, SCALING APS or LMCS APS).                 -   c) Alternatively, the value of ChromaArrayType may                     be constrained depending on the syntax element                     aps_chroma_present_flag and/or the type of the APS.                 -   d) In one example, it is required that, the value of                     aps_chroma_present_flag of the APS NAL unit having                     aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and                     adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to                     ph/slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be equal to 0 when                     chromaArrayType is equal to 0.                 -    a. Additionally, alternatively, it is required                     that, the value of aps_chroma_present_flag of the                     APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS                     and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to                     ph/slice_alf_aps_id_chroma (and/or                     ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id and/or ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id)                     shall be equal to 1 when chromaArrayType is greater                     than 0.                 -   e) In one example, it is required that, the value of                     aps_chroma_present_flag of the APS NAL unit having                     aps_params_type equal to SCALING_APS and                     adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to                     ph_scaling_list_aps_id shall be equal to 0 when                     chromaArrayType is equal to 0.                 -    a. Additionally, alternatively, it is required                     that, the value of aps_chroma_present_flag of the                     APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to                     SCALING_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to                     ph_scaling_list_aps_id shall be equal to 1 when                     chromaArrayType is greater than 0.                 -   f) In one example, it is required that, the value of                     aps_chroma_present_flag of the APS NAL unit having                     aps_params_type equal to LMCS_APS and                     adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_lmcs_aps_id                     shall be equal to 0 when chromaArrayType is equal to                     0.             -   x. Additionally, alternatively, it is required that, the                 value of aps_chroma_present_flag of the APS NAL unit                 having aps_params_type equal to LMCS_APS and                 adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_lmcs_aps_id                 shall be equal to 1 when chromaArrayType is greater                 than 0. Additionally, the constraint based on                 ChromaArrayType may be derived by the PH syntax elements                 or SH syntax elements, but regardless of the presence of                 the APS ID in the PH/SH.                 -   a) In one example, it is required that, the value of                     aps_chroma_present_flag of the APS NAL unit having                     aps_params_type equal to SCALING_APS and/or ALF_APS                     and/or LMCS APS shall be equal to 0 when                     chromaArrayType is equal to 0.                 -   b) Additionally, alternatively, it is required that,                     the value of aps_chroma_present_flag of the APS NAL                     unit having aps_params_type equal to SCALING_APS APS                     and/or ALF_APS and/or LMCS APS shall be equal to 1                     when chromaArrayType is greater than 0.     -   2. Regarding the signalling of deblocking control for solving         the second problem, one or more of the following approaches are         disclosed, e.g., as in the second set of embodiments:         -   a. In one example, an N-bit (such as N=2) deblocking mode             indicator (e.g., named deblocking_filter_mode_idc) is             signalled.             -   i. In one example, the syntax element                 deblocking_filter_mode_idc is u(2) coded.                 -   a) Alternatively, the parsing process of                     deblocking_filter_mode_idc is unsigned integer with                     N (such as N=2) bits.             -   ii. In one example, the syntax element                 deblocking_filter_mode_idc is signalled in the PPS.             -   iii. In one example, the syntax element                 deblocking_filter_mode_idc is used to specify the                 following four modes: a) deblocking fully disabled and                 not used for all slices; b) deblocking used for all                 slices using 0-valued β and tC offsets; c) deblocking                 used for all slices using β and tC offsets explicitly                 signalled in the PPS; and d) deblocking further                 controlled at either picture or slice level.         -   b. A syntax flag ph/slice_deblocking_filter_used_flag is             signalled either in the PH or SH, specifying whether             deblocking is used for the current picture/slice.         -   c. A syntax flag             ph/slice_deblocking_parameters_override_flag is signalled             either in the PH or SH, specifying whether the β and tC             offsets are overridden by the values signalled in the PH/SH.             -   i. Additionally, infer the value of                 slice_deblocking_parameters_override_flag to be equal to                 0 when not present.         -   d. In one example, the syntax elements specifying the             deblocking control (e.g., enable flag, disable flag, control             flag, deblocking mode indicator, deblocking filter beta/tc             parameters, and etc.) may be signalled in the SPS.             -   i. In one example, one or more syntax elements may be                 signalled in the SPS specifying whether the deblocking                 is enabled or not in the video unit (e.g., CLVS).             -   ii. Additionally, when the deblocking is disabled in the                 SPS, it is required that the syntax element in the                 PPS/PH/SH regarding the deblocking on/off control at                 PPS/PH/SH level shall be equal to a certain value that                 specifying the deblocking is fully disabled and not used                 for all slices.             -   iii. In one example, the deblocking filter control                 present flag may be signalled in the SPS.             -   iv. For example, an N-bit (such as N=2) deblocking mode                 indicator (e.g., named deblocking_filter_mode_idc) may                 be signalled in the SPS.             -   v. For example, beta/tc deblocking parameters may be                 signalled in the SPS.             -   vi. For example, whether the deblocking is enabled with                 0-valued beta/tc deblocking parameters may be dependent                 on the SPS syntax element.             -   vii. For example, the deblocking may be applied at the                 SPS/PPS/PH/SH level and use the beta/tc deblocking                 parameters signalled in the SPS.             -   viii. For example, the deblocking may be applied at the                 SPS/PPS/PH/SH level and use the 0-valued deblocking                 parameters signalled in the SPS.     -   3. Regarding the inference of the PPS syntax element         single_slice_per_subpic_flag for solving the third problem, one         or more of the following approaches are disclosed:         -   a. In one example, infer single_slice_per_subpic_flag to be             equal to 1 when no_pic_partition_flag is equal to 1, e.g.,             the semantics of single_slice_per_subpic_flag is changed as             follows:             -   single_slice_per_subpic_flag equal to 1 specifies that                 each subpicture consists of one and only one rectangular                 slice. slice_per_subpic_flag equal to 0 specifies that                 each subpicture may consist of one or more rectangular                 slices. When                 , the value of single_slice_per_subpic_flag is inferred                 to be equal to                 .     -   4. Regarding the picture or QP delta signalling for solving the         fourth problem, one or more of the following approaches are         disclosed:         -   a. In one example, picture or slice level chroma QP offset             are always signalled, either in the PH or SH.             -   i. For example, if there is chroma component in the                 video content (e.g., ChromaArrayType is not equal to 0),                 picture or slice level chroma QP offset may be always                 signalled, without conditioned on the present flag                 signalled in the PPS (e.g.,                 pps_slice_chroma_qp_offsets_present_flag).             -   ii. Alternatively, if there is chroma component in the                 video content (e.g., ChromaArrayType is not equal to 0),                 slice_cb_qp_offset and slice_cr_qp_offset syntax                 elements may be always present in the associated slice                 headers, regardless the PPS present flag (e.g.,                 pps_slice_chroma_qp_offsets_present_flag).             -   iii. Additionally, the present flag (e.g.,                 pps_slice_chroma_qp_offsets_present_flag) specifying the                 presence of slice_cb_qp_offset and slice_cr_qp_offset                 syntax elements, may be not signalled.         -   b. In one example, pps_cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag may be used             to specify the presence of cu_qp_delta_abs and             cu_qp_delta_sign_flag in both the transform unit syntax and             the palette coding syntax, and the semantics of             pps_cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag are changed as follows:             -   pps_cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that                 the ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_intra_slice and                 ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_inter_slice_syntax elements are                 present in PHs referring to the PPS, and                 cu_qp_delta_abs                 may be present in the transform unit syntax                 . pps_cu_qp_delta_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that                 the ph_cu_qp_delta_subdiv_intra_slice and                 ph_cu_delta_subdiv_inter_slice syntax elements are not                 present in PHs referring to the PPS, and                 cu_qp_delta_abs                 not present in the transform unit syntax                 .         -   c. In one example, the luma QP delta may be signalled in             both the PH and the SH.             -   i. For example, luma QP delta present flag may be                 signalled in the PPS and/or PH, and/or the SH.             -   ii. For example, whether the luma QP delta is signalled                 in PH/SH is dependent on the present flags in the PPS                 and/or PH/SH.             -   iii. For example, the values of the PH luma QP delta and                 the SH luma QP delta may be additive and used for                 calculating the luma quantization parameter such as                 SliceQp_(Y).         -   d. In one example, the chroma QP offsets may be signalled in             both the PH and the SH.             -   i. For example, chroma QP offsets present flag may be                 signalled in the PPS and/or PH, and/or the SH.             -   ii. For example, whether the chroma QP offsets are                 signalled in PH/SH is dependent on the present flags in                 the PPS and/or PH/SH.             -   iii. For example, the values of the PH chroma QP offsets                 and the SH chroma QP offsets may be additive and used                 for deriving the chroma quantization parameter for the                 Cb and Cr components.     -   5. Regarding the chroma Qp mapping tables, one or more of the         following approaches are disclosed:         -   a. In one example, in the derivation process of the chroma             QP table, the XOR operator should be performed between             (delta_qp_in_val_minus1[i][j]+1) and             delta_qp_diff_val[i][j], e.g. as in the third set of             embodiment.         -   b. It is proposed to have a flag in             sps_multiple_sets_of_chroma_qp_table_present_flag in SPS.             -   i. When                 sps_multiple_sets_of_chroma_qp_table_present_flag is                 equal to 0, only one set of chroma Qp mapping table is                 allowed to be signalled.             -   ii. When                 sps_multiple_sets_of_chroma_qp_table_present_flag is                 equal to 1, more than one set of chroma Qp mapping table                 are allowed to be signalled.         -   c. More than one set of chroma Qp mapping tables may be             disallowed to be signalled for a sequence without B/P             slices.     -   6. Regarding the sps_independent_subpics_flag and         subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] for solving the sixth problem, one         or more of the following approaches are disclosed:         -   a. In one example, the presence of             sps_independent_subpics_flag is dependent on whether the             number of subpictures is greater than 1.             -   i. For example, only when the number of subpictures is                 greater than 1 (e.g., if (sps_num_subpics_minus1>0)),                 sps_independent_subpics_flag is signalled.             -   ii. For example, when the number of subpictures is equal                 to 1 (e.g., if (sps_num_subpics_minus1==0)), then the                 signalling of sps_independent_subpics_flag is skipped.         -   b. Additionally, when sps_independent_subpics_flag is not             present, it is inferred to be equal to a certain value (such             as 0 or 1).         -   c. In one example, when subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is not             present, it is inferred to be equal to a certain value (such             as 0 or 1).         -   d. In one example, when subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is not             present, it is inferred to be equal to a certain value             wherein the wrap-around motion compensation is enabled (or             may be used).             -   i. Additionally, when subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is                 not present, it is inferred to be equal to a certain                 value wherein the horizontal wrap-around motion                 compensation is enabled (or may be used).         -   e. In one example, the inferred value of             subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] may be dependent on whether a             picture only consists of one subpicture; and/or whether the             subpicture has the same width as the picture.             -   i. In one example, if the subpicture has the same width                 as the picture, subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] may be                 inferred to X (e.g., X=0).         -   f. In one example, when sps_independent_subpics_flag is not             present, what value that sps_independent_subpics_flag is             inferred to may be dependent on other syntax element(s) or             variable(s).             -   i. For example, the inferred value may depend on whether                 the subpicture information is present or not (e.g.,                 subpic_info_present_flag is equal to 0 or 1).             -   ii. For example, when subpic_info_present_flag is equal                 to 0 and sps_independent_subpics_flag is not present, it                 is inferred to be equal to a certain value (such as 0 or                 1).             -   iii. For example, when subpic_info_present_flag is equal                 to 1 and sps_independent_subpics_flag is not present, it                 is inferred to be equal to a certain value (such as 0 or                 1).         -   g. In one example, when subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is not             present, what value that subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is             inferred to may be dependent on the presence of subpicture             information (e.g., subpic_info_present_flag) and/or the             number of subpictures in the CLVS (e.g.,             sps_num_subpics_minus1) and/or sps_independent_subpics_flag.             -   i. In one example, when subpic_info_present_flag is                 equal to 0, and subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is not                 present, the value of subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is                 inferred to be equal to a certain value (such as 0).             -   ii. In one example, when subpic_info_present_flag is                 equal to 1, and subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is not                 present, the value of subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is                 inferred to be equal to a certain value (such as 1).             -   iii. In one example, when subpic_info_present_flag is                 equal to 1, and sps_num_subpics_minus1 is equal to 0,                 and subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is not present, the                 value of subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is inferred to be                 equal to a certain value (such as 0 or 1).             -   iv. In one example, when subpic_info_present_flag is                 equal to 1, sps_num_subpics_minus1 is greater than 0,                 sps_independent_subpics_flag is equal to 1, and                 subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is not present, the value                 of subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i] is inferred to be equal                 to a certain value (such as 0 or 1).     -   7. How to do padding or clipping on a boundary during the         inter-prediction process may depend on a combined checking of         the type of boundary, the indication of wrap around padding or         clipping (e.g. pps_ref_wraparound_enabled_flag,         sps_ref_wraparound_enabled_flag, and etc.) and the indication of         treating subpicture boundary as picture boundary (e.g.         subpic_treated_as_pic_flag[i]).         -   a. For example, if a boundary is a picture boundary, the             indication of wrap around padding is true, wrap around             padding (or wrap around clipping) may be applied, without             considering the indication of treating subpicture boundary             as picture boundary.             -   i. In one example, the boundary must be a vertical                 boundary.         -   b. For example, if both two vertical boundaries are picture             boundaries, the indication of wrap around padding is true,             wrap around padding (or wrap around clipping) may be             applied, without considering the indication of treating             subpicture boundary as picture boundary.         -   c. In one example, the above wrap around padding (or wrap             around clipping) may indicate horizontal wrap-around             padding/clipping.     -   8. In one example, different indications for wrap around padding         or clipping may be signaled for different subpictures.     -   9. In one example, different offsets for wrap around padding or         clipping may be signaled for different subpictures.     -   10. In the PH/SH, a variable X is used to indicate whether B         slice is allowed/used in a picture/slice, and the variable may         be derived using one of the following ways: a)         (rpl_info_in_ph_flag && num_ref_entries[0][RplsIdx[0]]>0 &&         num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0); b) (rpl_info_in_ph_flag &&         num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0); c) (rpl_info_in_ph_flag &&         num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>1); d) (rpl_info_in_ph_flag &&         num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0); e) based on NumRefIdxActive         (e.g., NumRefIdxActive for list 1 greater than K (e.g., K=0)) in         the VVC text; f) based on number of allowed reference pictures         for list 1.         -   1) Alternatively, furthermore, signalling and/or semantics             and/or inference of one or multiple syntax elements             signalled in PH may be modified according to the variable.             -   i. In one example, the one or multiple syntax elements                 are those for enabling a coding tool which requires more                 than one prediction signal, such as bi-prediction or                 mixed intra and inter coding, or prediction with                 linear/non-linear weighting from multiple prediction                 blocks.             -   ii. In one example, the one or multiple syntax elements                 may include, but not limited to:                 -   a) ph_collocated_from_l0_flag                 -   b) mvd_l1_zero_flag                 -   c) ph_disable_bdof_flag                 -   d) ph_disable_dmvr_flag                 -   e) num_l1_weights             -   iii. In one example, only when the variable indicates                 that the picture may contain one or more B slices, the                 one or multiple syntax elements may be signalled.                 Otherwise, the signalling is skipped, and the values of                 the syntax element are inferred.                 -   a) Alternatively, furthermore, whether to signal the                     one or more syntax elements may depend on the first                     syntax elements in bullet 1.1) and 2.1), such as (X                     being true or 1).                 -   b) ph_disable_bdof_flag may be signalled only when                     (sps_bdof_pic_present_flag                     ) is true.                 -   c) ph_disable_dmvr_flag may be signalled only when                     (sps_dmvr_pic_present_flag                     ) is true.             -   iv. In one example, when X is equal to 0 (or false),                 mvd_l1_zero_flag is not signalled, and its values is                 inferred to be 1.             -   v. In one example, the inference of the one or multiple                 syntax elements are dependent on the value of the first                 syntax element.                 -   a) In one example, for the ph_disable_bdof_flag, the                     following applies:                 -    If sps_bdof_enabled_flag is equal to 1                     , the value of ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to                     be equal to 0.                 -    Otherwise (sps_bdof_enabled flag is equal to                     ), the value of ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to                     be equal to 1                 -   b) In one example, for the ph_disable_dmvr_flag, the                     following applies:                 -    If sps_dmvr_enabled_flag is equal to 1                     , the value of ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to                     the equal to 0.                 -    Otherwise (sps_dmvr_enabled_flag is equal to                     ), the value of ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to                     be equal to 1.                 -   c) In one example, when ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag                     and rpl_info_in_ph_flag are both equal to 1 and X is                     equal to 0 (or false), the value of                     ph_collocated_from_l0_flag is inferred to be equal                     to 1.                 -   d) In one example, when X is equal to 0 (or false),                     num_l1_weights is not signalled and its value is                     inferred to be 0, and, consequently, weighted                     prediction parameters for reference picture list 1                     are not signalled in the PH or SHs of the picture.     -   11. It is proposed that the signaling of indication of whether         to partition a picture into tiles/slices/subpictures (such as         no_pic_partition_flag in PPS) maybe conditioned on the number of         CTBs in a picture.         -   2) In one example, no_pic_partition_flag is not signaled if             the number of CTUs in a picture is equal to 1 (or smaller             than 2).         -   3) Alternatively, it is constrained that             no_pic_partition_flag shall be equal to 0 if the number of             CTUs in a picture is equal to 1 (or smaller than 2).     -   12. Regarding improving the syntax and semantics of deblocking         for solving the seventh problem, one or more of the following         approaches are disclosed, e.g., as in the fourth embodiment:         -   a. Whether the the operation of deblocking filter is             disabled (or enabled) for slices referring to the PPS is             dependent on both the deblocking syntax signalled in the PPS             (e.g., pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag) and the             deblocking syntax elements signalled at the picture or slice             level.             -   i. In one example, pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag                 equal to 1 specifies that the operation of deblocking                 filter is disabled for slices referring to the PPS                 unless indicated otherwise at the picture or slice                 level.             -   ii. In one example, pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag                 equal to 0 specifies that the operation of deblocking                 filter is enabled for slices referring to the PPS unless                 indicated otherwise at the picture or slice level.         -   b. Infer slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag to be equal             to 0 when not present.         -   c. Skip the signalling of deblocking on/off control flag in             the PH/SH when deblocking filter is disabled in the PPS and             going to be overridden in the PH/SH.             -   i. In one example, whether to signal deblocking on/off                 control flag in the PH (e.g.,                 ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag) may be dependent on                 whether the deblocking is disabled in the PPS (e.g.,                 whether the value of pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag                 is equal to 1 or not) and/or the override flag in the PH                 (e.g., ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag is equal to 1                 or not).                 -   a) For example, when                     pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag and                     ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag are equal to 1,                     the signalling of ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag                     may be skipped.                 -   b) Alternatively, when                     deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag and                     pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag and                     ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag are equal to 1,                     the signalling of ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag                     may be skipped.             -   ii. Additionally, when                 ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not present, it                 may be inferred as follows:                 -   a) If deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag,                     pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag and                     ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag are all equal to                     1, the value of ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag                     is inferred to be equal to 0.                 -   b) Otherwise, the value of                     ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is inferred to be                     equal to pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag.             -   iii. Additionally, alternatively, when                 ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not present, it                 may be inferred as follows:                 -   a) If pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag and                     ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag are all equal to                     1, the value of ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag                     is inferred to be equal to 0.                 -   b) Otherwise, the value of                     ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is inferred to be                     equal to pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag.             -   iv. In one example, whether to signal deblocking on/off                 control flag in the SH (e.g.,                 slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag) may be dependent                 on whether the deblocking is disabled in the PPS (e.g.,                 whether the value of pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag                 is equal to 1 or not) and/or the override flag in the SH                 (e.g., slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag is equal to                 1 or not).                 -   a) In one example, when                     deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag and                     pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag and                     slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag are equal to                     1, the signalling of                     slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag may be                     skipped.                 -   b) Alternatively, when                     pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag and                     slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag are equal to                     1, the signalling of                     slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag may be                     skipped.             -   v. Additionally, when                 slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not present, it                 may be inferred as follows:                 -   a) If deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag,                     pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag and                     slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag are all equal                     to 1, the value of                     slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is inferred to                     be equal to 0.                 -   b) Otherwise, the value of                     slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is inferred to                     be equal to pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag.             -   vi. Additionally, alternatively, when                 slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not present, it                 may be inferred as follows:                 -   a) If pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag and                     slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag are all equal                     to 1, the value of                     slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is inferred to                     be equal to 0.                 -   b) Otherwise, the value of                     slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is inferred to                     be equal to pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag.     -   13. It is proposed that cu_skip_flag may be skipped when         sps_ibc_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and block size is no smaller         than 64×64.         -   a. An example is shown in the fifth embodiment.     -   14. A first syntax element (SE) may be added in the ALF APS to         indicate whether chroma filtering information (e.g., chroma ALF,         CC-ALF) are present, and signalling of other syntax elements may         be based on the value of the first SE.         -   a. In one example, when the first SE (e.g.,             aps_chroma_present_flag in embodiment #6) indicates chroma             filtering information are not present, the signalling of             indication of luma filter information (e.g.,             alf_luma_filter_signal_flag) is skipped.             -   i. Alternatively, furthermore, the indication of luma                 filter information (e.g., alf_luma_filter_signal_flag)                 is inferred to be true.         -   b. In one example, when the first SE (e.g.,             aps_chroma_present_flag in embodiment #6) indicates chroma             filtering information are present, a constraint shall be             satisfied that at least one of indications of chroma filter             information (e.g., alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag,             alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag, alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag)             is true.     -   15. In above examples, the indication of CC-ALF filtering         presence information may be replaced from two syntax elements         (e.g., alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag,         alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag) by a syntax element (which may be         non-binary value, e.g., alf_cc_filter_idc).     -   16. It is required in a conformance bitstream that the first         coded slice of an IRAP or GDR picture in decoding order shall         not refer to a suffix APS NAL unit.         -   a. For example, when the first coded slice firstSlice of a             coded picture in decoding order has nal_unit_type equal to             IDR_W_RADL, IDR_N_LP, CRA_NUT, or GDR_NUT, firstSlice shall             not refer to a suffix APS NAL unit.     -   17. The constraint on disallowing updating the content of an APS         NAL unit within a PU may exclude specific APS NAL units.         -   a. For example, it is required in a conformance bitstream             that all APS NAL units with a particular value of             adaptation_parameter_set_id and a particular value of             aps_params_type within a PU, except the suffix APS NAL units             associated with the last VCL NAL unit in the PU in decoding             order, regardless of whether they are prefix or suffix APS             NAL units, shall have the same content.         -   b. Alternatively, it is required in a conformance bitstream             that all APS NAL units with a particular value of             nal_unit_type, adaptation_parameter_set_id and a particular             value of aps_params_type within a PU, except the suffix APS             NAL units associated with the last VCL NAL unit in the PU in             decoding order, shall have the same content.     -   18. In one example, the “content of an APS NAL unit” means the         bits in the APS RBSP except adaptation_parameter_set_id and         aps_params_type.         -   a. In one example, When SUFFIX APS NAL units are present in             a PU, they shall not proceed the last VCL NAL unit of the PU     -   19. It is required in a conformance bitstream that when SUFFIX         APS NAL units are present in a PU, they shall not proceed the         last VCL NAL unit of the PU     -   20. It is required in a conformance bitstream that two APS NAL         units with a particular value of adaptation_parameter_set_id and         a particular value of aps_params_type within a PU, regardless of         whether they are prefix or suffix APS NAL units, shall have the         same content, when there is no VCL NAL unit between the two APS         NAL units.     -   21. Regarding fixing the issues in the current draft text for         solving the tenth problem, one or more of the following         approaches are disclosed (changes are provided on top of the         latest VVC spec JVET-Q2001-vE, if any, added or modified are         highlighted in         , and the deleted parts are marked with double brackets (e.g.,         [[a]] denotes the deletion of the character “a”).         -   a. How to signal the APS ID (e.g.,             adaptation_parameter_set_id) is dependent on the APS type.             -   i. In one example, for the ALF APS, the APS ID may be                 coded with ue(v) or K-th EG coding.             -   ii. In one example, for the LMCS and Scaling list APSs,                 the APS ID may be coded with u(a) and u(b), respectively                 and a is unequal to b.             -   iii. In one example, for the LMCS and Scaling list APSs,                 the APS ID may be coded with ue(v) or K-th EG coding.         -   b. In one example, the APS ID (e.g.,             adaptation_parameter_set_id) is u(X) coded, such as X=3.             -   i. For example, the syntax of                 adaptation_parameter_set_id is changed as follows:

Descriptor adaptation_parameter_set_rbsp( ) {  adaptation_parameter_set_id u( 3 [[5]])

-   -   -   -   i. In one example, the X may be dependent on the maximum                 allowed number of APSs among all types of APSs.                 -   a. In one example, X is set to (X−(1<<log 2 (X))==0                     ? log 2 (X):(log 2 (X)+1).

        -   c. It is proposed to set the maximum allowed signalled             absolute value of ALF filter coefficient shall be equal to             (1<<K)−M (M is unequal to 0, e.g., K=7 M=1).             -   i. In one example, the range of ALF filter related                 syntax elements (e.g., alf_luma_coeff_abs[sfIdx][j],                 alf_chroma_coeff_abs[altIdx][j] in the alf_data( )                 syntax structure) shall be in the range of 0 to Y,                 inclusive, wherein Y is equal to 127.             -   ii. For example, the semantics of                 alf_luma_coeff_abs[sfIdx][j] are changed as follows:                 alf_luma_coeff_abs[sfIdx][j] specifies the absolute                 value of the j-th coefficient of the signalled luma                 filter indicated by sfIdx. When                 alf_luma_coeff_abs[sfIdx][j] is not present, it is                 inferred to be equal 0. The value of                 alf_luma_coeff_abs[sfIdx][j] shall be in the range of 0                 to [[128]]127, inclusive.             -   iii. For example, the semantics of                 alf_chroma_coeff_abs[altIdx][j are changed as follows:                 -   alf_chroma_coeff_abs[altIdx][j] specifies the                     absolute value of the j-th chroma filter coefficient                     for the alternative chroma filter with index altIdx.                     When alf_chroma_coeff_abs[altIdx][j] is not present,                     it is inferred to be equal 0. The value of                     alf_chroma_coeff_abs[sfIdx][j] shall be in the range                     of 0 to 127, inclusive.

        -   d. In one example, a value range is specified to the             semantics of CCALF related syntax elements (e.g.,             alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j], alf_cc_cr_mapped             coeff_abs[k][j] in the alf_data( ) syntax structure) to             constrain the value of the corresponding syntax element to             be in a valid range.             -   i. For example, the value of CCALF related syntax                 elements (e.g., alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j],                 alf_cc_cr_mapped coeff_abs[k][j]) shall be in the range                 of X to Y, inclusive, such as X=1 and Y=8.             -   ii. For example, the semantics of                 alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j] are changed as follows:                 -   alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j] specifies the                     absolute value of the j-th mapped coefficient of the                     signalled k-th cross-component filter for the Cb                     colour component. When                     alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j] is not present, it                     is inferred to be equal to 0.                     ,                     .             -   iii. For example, the semantics of alf_cc_cr_mapped                 coeff_abs[k][j] are changed as: alf_cc_cr_mapped                 coeff_abs[k][j] specifies the absolute value of the j-th                 mapped coefficient of the signalled k-th cross-component                 filter for the Cr colour component. When                 alf_cc_cr_mapped coeff_abs[k][j] is not present, it is                 inferred to be equal to 0.                 ,                 .

        -   e. In one example, instead of coding             alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j] in the alf_data( ) syntax             structure, the absolute value minus 1 (denoted by             alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs_minus1[k][j]) may be coded, and             the absolute value of a CC-ALF filter coefficient is derived             to be:

(1−2*alf_cc_cb_coeff_sign[k][j])*2^(alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs_minus1[k][j]+1).

-   -   -   -   i. Alternatively, furthermore, the signalled                 alf_cc_cb_mapped_coeff_abs_minus1[k][j] shall be in the                 range of [0, (1<<K)−1] wherein K is a positive integer                 (e.g., K=3).

        -   f. In one example, instead of coding             alf_cc_cr_mapped_coeff_abs[k][j] in the alf_data( ) syntax             structure, the absolute value minus 1 (denoted by             alf_cc_cr_mapped_coeff_abs_minus1[k][j]) may be coded, and             the absolute value of a CC-ALF filter coefficient is derived             to be:

(1−2*alf_cc_cr_coeff_sign[k][j])*2^(alf_cc_cr_mapped_coeff_abs_minus1[k][j]+1).

-   -   -   -   i. Alternatively, furthermore, the signalled                 alf_cc_cr_mapped_coeff_abs_minus1[k][j] shall be in the                 range of [0, (1<<K)−1] wherein K is a positive integer                 (e.g., K=3).

        -   g. The number of ALF APS for luma component may be signalled             in the PH/SH.             -   i. For example, the semantics of ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma                 may be changed as follows. ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma                 specifies the number of ALF APSs                 that the slices associated with the PH refers to.             -   ii. For example, the semantics of                 slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma may be changed as follows.                 slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma specifies the number of ALF                 APSs                 that the slice refers to. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is                 equal to 1 and slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma is not                 present, the value of slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma is                 inferred to be equal to the value of                 ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma.

    -   22. Regarding a constraint on the total memory used or the         number of filters in the APSs rather than the number of APSs for         solving the eleventh problem, one or more of the following         approaches are disclosed (changes are provided on top of the         lastest VVC spec JVET-Q2001-vE, if any, added or modified are         highlighted in bold and Italic, and the deleted parts are marked         with double brackets (e.g., [[a]] denotes the deletion of the         character “a”).         -   a. In one example, constraints are specified to limit the             total number of ALF APSs.             -   i. For example, the total number of ALF APSs is not                 equal to the total number of SCALING APSs.             -   ii. For example, the total number of ALF APSs may be                 dependent on the number of ALF filters (e.g., ALF luma                 filters, ALF chroma filters, CCALF Cb filter, CCALF Cr                 filters).             -   iii. For example, a constraint is specified in the spec                 to limit the total number of ALF APSs shall be equal to                 X (such as X=328).             -   iv. For example, the semantics of                 adaptation_parameter_set_id are changed as follows:                 adaptation_parameter_set_id provides an identifier for                 the APS for reference by other syntax elements.                 -   When aps_params_type is equal to ALF_APS, the value                     of adaptation_parameter_set_id shall be in the range                     of 0 to X, inclusive. (                     ,                     ,                     . When aps_params_type is equal to LMCS_APS the                     value of adaptation_parameter_set_id shall be in the                     range of 0 to 3, inclusive.         -   b. In one example, constraints are specified to limit the             total number of ALF luma filters, and/or ALF chroma filters,             and/or CCALF filters.             -   i. For example, constraints are specified to limit the                 total number of ALF luma filters in all ALF APSs shall                 be equal to X1 (such as X=200).             -   ii. For example, constraints are specified to limit the                 total number of ALF chroma filters in all ALF APSs shall                 be equal to X2 (such as X=64).             -   iii. For example, constraints are specified to limit the                 total number of CCALF filters in all ALF APSs shall be                 equal to X3 (such as X=64).                 -   a) Alternatively, a constraint is specified to limit                     the total number of CCALF Cb filters in all ALF APSs                     shall be equal to Y1 (such as Y1=32).                 -   b) Additionally, a constraint is specified to limit                     the total number of CCALF Cr filters in all ALF APSs                     shall be equal to Y2 (such as Y2=32).             -   iv. For example, some constraints may be added as                 follows:                 ,                 ,                 ,                 .             -   v. Alternatively, some constraints may be added as                 follows:                 ,                 ,                 ,                 ,                 .             -   vi. For example, a value range is specified to constrain                 the value of ph/slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma to be in the                 range of K1 to K2, inclusive.                 -   a) For example, the semantics of PH syntax element                     ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma may be changed as follows:                 -    ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma specifies the number of ALF                     APSs that the slices associated with the PH refers                     to,                     ,                     .                 -   b) Additionally, the semantics of PH syntax element                     slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma may be changed as                     follows:                 -    slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma specifies the number of                     ALF APSs that the slice refers to. When                     slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and                     slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma is not present, the value                     of slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma is inferred to be                     equal to the value of ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma.                     ,                     .         -   c. In one example, a value range is specified to constrain             the value of ALF APS ID to be in the range of K1 to K2,             inclusive.             -   i. For example, the range of the ALF APS ID signalled in                 the PH/SH (e.g., ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i],                 ph_alf_aps_id_chroma, ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id,                 ph_cr_alf_cb_aps_id) may be constrained to be in the                 range of K1 to K2, inclusive.             -   ii. For example, the semantics of PH syntax elements may                 be changed as follows:                 -   ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the                     adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that                     the luma component of the slices associated with the                     PH refers to.                     ,                     .                 -   ph_alf_aps_id_chroma specifies the                     adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the                     chroma component of the slices associated with the                     PH refers to.                     ,                     .                 -   ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id specifies the                     adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the                     Cb colour component of the slices associated with                     the PH refers to.                     ,                     .                 -   ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id specifies the                     adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the                     Cr colour component of the slices associated with                     the PH refers to.                     ,                     .             -   iii. For example, the semantics of SH syntax elements                 may be changed as follows:                 -   slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the                     adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that                     the luma component of the slice refers to. The                     TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having                     aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and                     adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to                     slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be less than or equal                     to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When                     slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and                     slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is not present, the value                     of slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is inferred to be equal                     to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i].                     ,                     .                 -   slice_alf_aps_id_chroma specifies the                     adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the                     chroma component of the slice refers to. The                     TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having                     aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and                     adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to                     slice_alf_aps_id_chroma shall be less than or equal                     to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When                     slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and                     slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is not present, the value of                     slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is inferred to be equal to                     the value of ph_alf_aps_id_chroma.                     ,                     .                 -   slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id specifies the                     adaptation_parameter_set_id that the Cb colour                     component of the slice refers to.                 -   The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having                     aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and                     adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to                     slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be less than or equal                     to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When                     slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and                     slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is not present, the value of                     slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is inferred to be equal to                     the value of ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id.                     ,                     .                 -   slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id specifies the                     adaptation_parameter_set_id that the Cr colour                     component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of                     the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to                     ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to                     slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be less than or equal                     to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When                     slice_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and                     slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is not present, the value of                     slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is inferred to be equal to                     the value of ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id.                     ,                     .         -   d. In one example, the binarization of ALF APS ID (e.g.,             ph(slice)_alf_aps_id_luma[i], ph(slice)_alf_aps_id_chroma,             ph(slice)_cc_alf_cb_aps_id, ph(slice)_cc_alf_cr_aps_id in             the PH/SH syntax structure) may be ue(v) coded, e.g., as in             the eighth embodiment.         -   e. In one example, the binarization of the number of ALF             APSs (e.g., ph(slice)_num_alf_aps_ids_luma in the PH/SH             syntax) may be ue(v) coded, e.g., as in the eighth             embodiment.         -   f. In one example, the binarization of APS ID (e.g.,             adaptation_parameter_set_id in the APS syntax structure) may             be dependent on the APS type, e.g., as in the eighth             embodiment.             -   i. For example, adaptation_parameter_set_id is u(X1)                 coded when aps_params_type is equal to ALF_APS, wherein                 X1=9.             -   ii. For example, adaptation_parameter_set_id is u(X2)                 coded when aps_params_type is equal to LMCS_APS, wherein                 X2=2.             -   iii. For example, adaptation_parameter_set_id is u(X3)                 coded when aps_params_type is equal to SCALING_APS,                 wherein X3=3.         -   g. In one example, whether the binarization of APS ID (e.g.,             adaptation_parameter_set_id in the APS syntax structure) is             ue(v) coded may be dependent on the APS type, e.g., as in             the ninth embodiment.             -   i. For example, adaptation_parameter_set_id is ue(v)                 coded when aps_params_type is equal to ALF_APS.         -   h. In one example, the binarization of APS ID (e.g.,             adaptation_parameter_set_id in the APS syntax structure) is             ue(v) coded, e.g., as in the tenth embodiment.

    -   23. It is required that all APS NALs of specific type (such as         ALF APS, or LMCS APS, or SCALING APS) in a PU must be signaled         before the last VCL NAL in the PU.

    -   24. It is required that all APS NALs of specific type (such as         ALF APS, or LMCS APS, or SCALING APS) in a PU must be signaled         before the first VCL NAL in the PU.

    -   25. It is required that the number of a first set of APS NALs of         specific type (such as ALF APS, or LMCS APS, or SCALING APS)         that are used or referred to by any VCL NALs (such as referred         by the APS index in a picture header or a slice header) in a PU,         wherein an APS NAL in the first set may be in the PU or not,         shall be no greater than X, wherein X is an integer such as 8.         -   a. In one example, X is signaled from the encoder to the             decoder.

    -   26. It is required that the number of a first set of APS NALs of         specific type (such as ALF APS, or LMCS APS, or SCALING APS)         that are used or referred to by any VCL NALs (such as referred         by the APS index in a picture header or a slice header) in a PU,         wherein an APS NAL in the first set may be in the PU or not,         plus the number of a second set of APS NALs of specific type         (such as ALF APS, or LMCS APS, or SCALING APS) that are NOT used         or referred to by any VCL NALs (such as referred by the APS         index in a picture header or a slice header) in a PU, wherein an         APS NAL in the second set is in the PU, shall be no greater than         X, wherein X is an integer such as 8.         -   a. In one example, X is signaled from the encoder to the             decoder.

    -   27. It is required that if the reference picture with index=0 in         reference list 0 is a long-term reference picture, at least one         reference picture of the collocated picture used for TMVP shall         be long-term reference picture.

    -   28. It is required that if the reference picture with index=0 in         reference list 0 is a short-term reference picture, at least one         reference picture of the collocated picture used for TMVP shall         be short-term reference picture.

    -   29. When Adaptive Color Transform (ACT) is used in a block,         coding tool X may be disallowed to be used in the block.         -   a. Alternatively, when coding tool X is used in a block, ACT             may be disallowed to be used in the block.         -   b. Coding tool X may be (The abbreviations are defined in             JVET-Q2001)             -   i. LFNST             -   ii. MTS             -   iii. Transform Skip             -   iv. Dual tree coding             -   v. Local dual tree coding             -   vi. Sign Data Hiding             -   vii. Dependent quantization             -   viii. LMCS

    -   30. In one example, whether to signal a first Syntax Element         (SE) that indicates whether to signal Motion Vector Difference         (MVD) for reference picture list (RPL)-1 may depend on a second         SE indicating whether reference picture list information is         signaled in Picture Header (PH), and the number of reference         pictures in RPL-1 (e.g., the number of reference pictures is         greater than 0) when the RPL information is present in PH.         -   a. In one example, the first SE may be mvd_l1_zero_flag as             specified in JVET-Q2001.         -   b. In one example, the second SE may be rpl_info_in_ph_flag             as specified in JVET-Q2001.         -   c. In one example, the number of reference pictures in RPL-1             may be set equal to num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] as             specified in JVET-Q2001.         -   d. The signalling of the first SE may be dependent on the             following condition:

if(!rpl_info_in_ph_flag∥num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0)

-   -   -   -   i. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 true, the SE may be signalled.             -   ii. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 false (e.g., when rpl_info_in_ph_flag is true and                 num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is equal to 0), the SE is                 not signalled and inferred.

        -   e. When the first SE is not signaled, it is inferred to be a             value X.             -   i. For example, X is equal to 0.             -   ii. For example, X is equal to 1.             -   iii. For example, X is equal to a SE/variable.             -   iv. For example, the derivation of X is based on or                 conditioned by one or multiple SEs/variables.

        -   f. An example is shown in the eleventh embodiment.

        -   g. An example is shown in the twelfth embodiment.

    -   31. In one example, whether to signal a first Syntax Element         (SE) that indicates whether to disable decoder motion vector         refinement (DMVR) may depend on a second SE indicating whether         reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in Picture         Header (PH), and the number of reference pictures in RPL-1) when         the RPL information is present in PH, and/or whether         sps_dmvr_pic_present_flag is equal to 1.         -   a. In one example, the first SE may be ph_disable_dmvr_flag             as specified in JVET-Q2001.         -   b. In one example, the second SE may be rpl_info_in_ph_flag             as specified in JVET-Q2001.         -   c. In one example, the number of reference pictures in RPL-1             may be set equal to num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] as             specified in JVET-Q2001.         -   d. The signalling of the first SE may be dependent on the             following condition:

if(sps_dmvr_pic_present_flag&&(!rpl_info_in_ph_flag∥(num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0)))

-   -   -   -   i. Alternatively, furthermore, when the conditions are                 true, the SE may be signalled.             -   ii. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 false (e.g., when rpl_info_in_ph_flag is true and                 num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is equal to 0, or when                 sps_dmvr_pic_present_flag is false), the SE is not                 signalled and inferred.

        -   e. When the first SE is not signaled, it is inferred to be a             value X.             -   i. For example, X is equal to 0.             -   ii. For example, X is equal to 1.             -   iii. For example, X is equal to a SE/variable.             -   iv. For example, the derivation of X is based on or                 conditioned by one or multiple SEs/variables.                 -   a) In one example, when ph_disable_dmvr_flag is not                     present, the following applies:                 -    If rpl_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 1 and                     num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is equal to 0,                     ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be 1.                 -    Otherwise (either rpl_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 0                     or num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is greater than                     0), ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be                     (1−sps_dmvr_enabled_flag)).                 -   b) For example:                 -    When ph_disable_dmvr_flag is not present, the                     following applies:                 -    If sps_dmvr_enabled_flag is equal to 0, the value                     of ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be equal to                     1.                 -    Otherwise, the following applies:                 -    If rpl_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 1 and                     num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is equal to 0,                     ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be 1.                 -    Otherwise, ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be                     0.                 -   c) For example:                 -    When ph_disable_dmvr_flag is not present, the                     following applies:                 -    If sps_dmvr_enabled_flag is equal to 0, the value                     of ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be equal to                     1.                 -    Otherwise, ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be                     (rpl_info_in_ph_flag==1 &&                     num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]==0) ? 1:0                 -   d) For example:                 -    When ph_disable_dmvr_flag is not present, it is                     inferred equal to be sps_dmvr_enabled_flag ?                     ((rpl_info_in_ph_flag==1 &&                     num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]==0) ? 1:0):1.                 -    e) For example:                 -    When ph_disable_dmvr_flag is not present, it is                     inferred equal to be                     (sps_dmvr_enabled_flag==0∥((rpl_info_in_ph_flag==1                     && num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]==0) ? 1:0.

        -   f. An example is shown in the eleventh embodiment.

        -   g. An example is shown in the twelfth embodiment.

    -   32. In one example, whether to signal a first Syntax Element         (SE) that indicates whether to disable bi-directional optical         flow (BDOF) may depend on a second SE indicating whether         reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in Picture         Header (PH), and the number of reference pictures in RPL-1         (e.g., the number of reference pictures is greater than 0) when         the RPL information is present in PH, and/or         sps_bdof_pic_present_flag.         -   a. In one example, the first SE may be ph_disable_bdof_flag             as specified in JVET-Q2001.         -   b. In one example, the second SE may be rpl_info_in_ph_flag             as specified in JVET-Q2001.         -   c. In one example, the number of reference pictures in RPL-1             may be set equal to num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] as             specified in JVET-Q2001.         -   d. The signalling of the first SE may be dependent on the             following condition:

if(sps_bdof_pic_present_flag&&(!rpl_info_in_ph_flag∥(num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0)))

-   -   -   -   i. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 true, the SE may be signalled.             -   ii. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 false (e.g., when rpl_info_in_ph_flag is true and                 num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is equal to 0, or when                 sps_bdof_pic_present_flag is false), the SE is not                 signalled and inferred.

        -   e. When the first SE is not signaled, it is inferred to be a             value X.             -   i. For example, X is equal to 0.             -   ii. For example, X is equal to 1.             -   iii. For example, X is equal to a SE/variable.             -   iv. For example, the derivation of X is based on or                 conditioned by one or multiple SEs/variables.                 -   a) For example:                 -    When ph_disable_bdof_flag is not present, the                     following applies:                 -    If sps_bdof_enabled_flag is equal to 0, the value                     of ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be equal to                     1.                 -    Otherwise, the following applies:                 -    If rpl_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 1 and                     num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is equal to 0,                     ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be 1.                 -    Otherwise, ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be                     0.                 -   b) For example:                 -    When ph_disable_bdof_flag is not present, the                     following applies:                 -    If sps_bdof_enabled_flag is equal to 0, the value                     of ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be equal to                     1.                 -    Otherwise, ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be                     (rpl_info_in_ph_flag==1 &&                     num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]==0) ? 1:0                 -   c) For example:                 -    When ph_disable_bdof_flag is not present, it is                     inferred equal to be sps_bdof_enabled_flag ?                     ((rpl_info_in_ph_flag==1 &&                     num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]=0) ? 1:0):1.                 -   d) For example:                 -    When ph_disable_bdof_flag is not present, it is                     inferred equal to be                     (sps_bdof_enabled_flag==0∥((rpl_info_in_ph_flag==1                     && num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]==0) ? 1:0.                 -   e) In one example, when ph_disable_bdof_flag is not                     present, the following applies:                 -    If rpl_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 1 and                     num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is equal to 0,                     ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be 1.                 -    Otherwise (either rpl_info_in_ph_flag is equal to 0                     or num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is greater than                     0), ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be                     (1—sps_bdof_enabled_flag)).

        -   f. An example is shown in the eleventh embodiment.

        -   g. An example is shown in the twelfth embodiment.

    -   33. In one example, whether to signal a first Syntax Element         (SE) that indicates whether the collocated picture used for         temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference         picture list 0 may depend on a second SE indicating whether         reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in Picture         Header (PH), and the number of reference pictures in RPL-1         (e.g., the number of reference pictures is greater than 0) when         the RPL information is present in PH, and whether TMVP is         enabled for a picture (e.g., ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag).         -   a. In one example, the first SE may be             ph_collocated_from_l0_flag as specified in JVET-Q2001.         -   b. In one example, the second SE may be rpl_info_in_ph_flag             as specified in JVET-Q2001.         -   c. In one example, the number of reference pictures in RPL-1             may be set equal to num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] as             specified in JVET-Q2001.         -   d. In one example, the first SE may be signalled when the             following condition is true:

if(ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag &&(!rpl_info_in_ph_flag∥num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0)

-   -   -   -   i. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 true, the first SE may be signalled.             -   ii. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 false (e.g., when rpl_info_in_ph_flag is true and                 num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is equal to 0, or when                 ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag is false), the SE is not                 signalled and inferred.

        -   e. In one example, the first SE may be signalled when the             following condition is true:

if(ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag && rpl_info_in_ph_flag&&num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0)

-   -   -   -   i. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 true, the first SE may be signalled.             -   ii. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 false (e.g., when rpl_info_in_ph_flag is true and                 num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is equal to 0, or when                 ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag is false), the SE is not                 signalled and inferred.

        -   f. When the first SE is not signaled, it is inferred to be a             value X.             -   i. For example, X is equal to 0.             -   ii. For example, X is equal to 1.             -   iii. For example, X is equal to a SE/variable.             -   iv. For example, the derivation of X is based on or                 conditioned by one or multiple SEs/variables.

        -   g. An example is shown in the eleventh embodiment.

        -   h. An example is shown in the twelfth embodiment.

    -   34. Whether to signal pred_weight_table( ) may depend on a         second SE indicating whether weighted prediction (WP)         information is signalled in PH, and whether reference picture         list (RPL) information is signaled in Picture Header (PH), and         the number of reference pictures in RPL-1 (e.g., the number of         reference pictures is greater than 0) when the RPL information         is present in PH, and whether pps_weighted_pred_flag and/or         pps_weighted_bipred_flag.         -   a. In one example, the pred_weight_table( ) may be signalled             when the following condition is true:

if((pps_weighted_pred_flag∥(pps_weighted_bipred_flag

∥

)&&wp_info_in_ph_flag)

-   -   -   -   i. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 true, the pred_weight_table( ) may be signalled in PH.             -   ii. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 false (e.g., when pps_weighted_bipred_flag,                 wp_info_in_ph_flag and rpl_info_in_ph_flag are true and                 num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is equal to 0, or                 ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag is false), the                 pred_weight_table( ) is not signalled.

    -   35. Whether to signal num_l1_weights in the pred_weight_table (         ) may depend on a second SE indicating whether weighted         prediction (WP) information is signalled in PH, and whether         reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in Picture         Header (PH), and the number of reference pictures in RPL1 (e.g.,         greater than 0) when the RPL information is present in PH, and         pps_weighted_bipred_flag.         -   a. In one example, the num_l1_weights in the             pred_weight_table( ) may be signalled when the following             condition is true:

if((pps_weighted_bipred_flag

∥

))&& wp_info_in_ph_flag)

-   -   -   -   i. Alternatively, the above condition may be replaced                 by:

if(pps_weighted_bipred_flag

&& wp_info_in_ph_flag)

-   -   -   -   ii. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 true, the num_l1_weights may be signalled in PH.             -   iii. Alternatively, furthermore, when the condition is                 false (e.g., when either one of the                 pps_weighted_bipred_flag, wp_info_in_ph_flag and                 num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is equal to 0), the                 num_l1_weights is not signalled and inferred (e.g., to                 be 0).                 -   a) Alternatively, when the condition is false, the                     num_l1_weights is not signalled, the value is not                     inferred, and the variable NumWeightsL1 is derived                     as follows:

if( !pps_weighted_bipred_flag | | ( wp _info_in_ph_flag && num _ref_entries[ 1 ][ RslsIdx[ 1 ] ] = = 0 ) ) NumWeightsL1 = 0 else if( wp_info_in_ph_flag )   (148)    NumWeightsL1 = num_l1_weights   else    NumWeightsL1 = NumRefIdxActive[ 1 ]  b) Alternatively, when the condition is false, the num_l1_weights is not signalled, the   value is not inferred, and the derivation of the variable NumWeightsL1 is dependent   on one or more of whether the WP info is signaled in PH (e.g., wp_info_in_ph_flag) ,   whether the RPL is signaled in the PH (e.g., rpl_info_in_ph_flag), and whether the   number of reference entries in RPL-1 is equal to 0, e.g., as follows:   The variable NumWeightsL1 is derived as follows:   if( !pps_weighted_bipred_flag ) NumWeightsL1 = 0    else if (wp _info_in_ph_flag && rpl_info_in_ph_flag &&    num _ref_entries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx[ 1 ] ] == 0 ) NumWeightL1 = 0   else if( wp_info_in_ph_flag)    NumWeightsL1 = num_l1_weights               (148)   else    NumWeightsL1 = NumRefIdxActive[ 1 ] b. An example is shown in the eleventh embodiment. c. An example is shown in the twelfth embodiment.

-   -   36. In one example, the APS ID (i.e., the syntax element         adaptation_parameter_set_id) is coded as u(3) instead of u(5).         -   a. In one example, additionally, the current 5-bit             adaptation_parameter_set_id is split into two syntax             elements, aps_reserved_zero_2bits, coded as u(2), followed             by adaptation_parameter_set_id, coded as u(3). This way, in             the future, if some more types of APSs need to be specified             and need more than 3 bits for the APS ID, the two reserved             bits can be utilized in a manner that is backward compatible             to earlier versions of VVC.             -   i. In one example, additionally, the semantics of these                 two syntax elements are as follows:                 aps_reserved_zero_2bits shall be equal to 0 in                 bitstreams conforming to this version of this                 Specification. The values greater than 0 for                 aps_reserved_zero_2bits are reserved for future use by                 ITU-T|ISO/IEC. adaptation_parameter_set_id provides an                 identifier for the APS for reference by other syntax                 elements.         -   b. In one example, additionally, the current 5-bit             adaptation_parameter_set_id is split into two syntax             elements, aps_reserved_zero_bit, coded as u(1), followed by             adaptation_parameter_set_id, coded as u(3), and another bit             is used for something else, e.g., a flag that specifies the             presence of chroma related syntax elements in the APS. This             way, in the future, if some more types of APSs need to be             specified and need more than 3 bits for the APS ID, the one             reserved bit can be utilized in a manner that is backward             compatible to earlier versions of VVC.             -   i. In one example, the semantics of these two syntax                 elements are as follows: aps_reserved_zero_bit shall be                 equal to 0 in bitstreams conforming to this version of                 this Specification. The value 1 for                 aps_reserved_zero_bit is reserved for future use by                 ITU-T ISO/IEC. adaptation_parameter_set_id provides an                 identifier for the APS for reference by other syntax                 elements.     -   37. Regarding the parsing order of general constraint flags to         solve the problem thirteen,         -   a. In one example, in the general constraint information             general_constraint_info( ) syntax structure, the syntax             elemented are grouped together according to a rule. The             general constraints information syntax structure includes a             set of syntax elements indicating whether one or more             particular constraints are imposed to the video bitstream,             e.g., in terms of constrain the value of a SPS/PPS/PH/SH             syntax element to disable a coding tool or functionality in             the video bitstream.         -   i. For example, the rule is defined as inter-related syntax             elements, and intra-related syntax elements.         -   ii. for example, the rule is defined as coding tools related             syntax elements, and functionality related syntax elements.     -   38. Whether to signal the indications of allowing intra slices         (e.g., ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag) within a picture may depend         on whether inter slice is allowed (e.g.,         ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag) and there are more than one         partition (e.g., more than one slice/tile).         -   a. In one example, when the following condition is true, the             indication of allowing intra slice may be signalled.             -   “ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag &&                 ”.                 -   i. Alternatively, furthermore, when the above                     condition is false, the signalling of                     ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag is skipped and inferred.                 -   ii. Alternatively, furthermore, when                     ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag is not present, the                     value of ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag is inferred to                     be equal to (!ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag) or                     (1−ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag).

6. EMBODIMENTS

Below are some example embodiments for some of the invention aspects summarized above in Section 5, which can be applied to the VVC specification. The changed texts are based on the latest VVC text in JVET-Q2001-vE. Most relevant parts that have been added or modified are bold and Italic, and some of the deleted parts are marked with double brackets (e.g., [[a]] denotes the deletion of the character “a”).

6.1. First Set of Embodiments

This is a set of embodiments for items 1 summarized above in Section 5.

6.1.1. An Embodiment for 1.a.i

ph_scaling_list_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the scaling list APS.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to SCALING_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_scaling_list_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with PH.

,

. (alternatively, it may be phrased as follows:

).

. . .

scaling_list_chroma_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that chroma scaling lists are present in scaling_list_data( ).

-   -   scaling_list_chroma_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that         chroma scaling lists are not present in scaling_list_data( ).

6.1.2. An Embodiment for 1.a.ii

ph_scaling_list_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the scaling list APS.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to SCALING_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_scaling_list_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with PH.

. (alternatively, it may be phrased as follows: The

).

. . .

scaling_list_chroma_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that chroma scaling lists are present in scaling_list_data( ). scaling_list_chroma_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that chroma scaling lists are not present in scaling_list_data( ).

6.1.3. An Embodiment for 1.b.i

ph_lmcs_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the LMCS APS that the slices associated with the PH refers to.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to LMCS_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_lmcs_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with PH.

.

6.1.4. An Embodiment for 1.b.ii

ph_lmcs_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the LMCS APS that the slices associated with the PH refers to.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to LMCS_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_lmcs_aps_id shall less than or equal to the TemporalId the picture associated with PH.

.

6.1.5. An Embodiment for 1.c.i

The semantics of PH syntax elements are changes as follows:

ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

The value of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be equal to 1.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id [i] shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with the PH.

,

.

. . .

The semantics of SH syntax elements are changes as follows:

. . .

slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slice refers to. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is not present, the value of slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i].

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit.

The value of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_prep_id equal to slice alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be equal to 1.

,

.

. . .

And the semantics of the APS syntax elements in the ALF data syntax structure are changed as follows:

. . .

alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that a chroma filter is signalled. alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that a chroma filter is not signalled.

. . .

alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cb colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for Cb colour component are not signalled.

alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are not signalled.

6.1.6. An Embodiment for 1.c.ii

The semantics of PH syntax elements are changes as follows:

ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

The value of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be equal to 1.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with the PH.

,

,

,

.

ph_alf_chroma_idc equal to 0 specifies that the adaptive loop filter is not applied to Cb and Cr colour components. ph_alf_chroma_idc equal to 1 indicates that the adaptive loop filter is applied to the Cb colour component. ph_alf_chroma_idc equal to 2 indicates that the adaptive loop filter is applied to the Cr colour component. ph_alf_chroma_idc equal to 3 indicates that the adaptive loop filter is applied to Cb and Cr colour components. When ph_alf_chroma_idc is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

. . .

The semantics of SH syntax elements are changes as follows:

. . .

slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slice refers to. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is not present, the value of slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i].

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit.

The value of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be equal to 1

,

,

,

.

. . .

And the semantics of the APS syntax elements in the ALF data syntax structure are changed as follows:

. . .

alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that a chroma filter is signalled. alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that a chroma filter is not signalled.

. . .

alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cb colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for Cb colour component are not signalled.

alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are not signalled.

6.1.7. An Embodiment for 1.c.iii

The semantics of PH syntax elements are changes as follows:

. . .

ph_alf_aps_id_chroma specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the chroma component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

The value of alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id chroma shall be equal to 1

.

. . .

ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the Cb colour component of the slices associated with the PH refers to

The value of alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be equal to 1

.

. . .

ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the Cr colour component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

The value of alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be equal to 1.

.

. . .

The semantics of SH syntax elements are changes as follows:

. . .

slice_alf_aps_id_chroma specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the chroma component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_chroma shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is not present, the value of slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_chroma.

The value of alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id chroma shall be equal to 1.

.

. . .

slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id that the Cb colour component of the slice refers to.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is not present, the value of slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id.

The value of alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be equal to 1.

,

.

. . .

slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id that the Cr colour component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is not present, the value of slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id.

The value of alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be equal to 1.

,

.

. . .

And the semantics of APS syntax elements are changed as follows:

. . .

alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that a chroma filter is signalled. alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that a chroma filter is not signalled.

. . .

alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cb colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for Cb colour component are not signalled.

alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are not signalled.

. . .

6.1.8. An Embodiment for 1.d.i

The semantics of APS syntax elements in the ALF data syntax structure are changed as follows:

. . .

alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that a chroma filter is signalled. alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that a chroma filter is not signalled.

. . .

alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cb colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for Cb colour component are not signalled.

alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are not signalled.

. . .

6.1.9. An Embodiment for 1.d.ii

The semantics of APS syntax elements in the SCALING LIST data syntax structure are changed as follows:

. . .

scaling_list_chroma_present_flag equal to 1 specifies that chroma scaling lists are present in scaling_list_data( ). scaling_list_chroma_present_flag equal to 0 specifies that chroma scaling lists are not present in scaling_list_data( ).

6.1.10. An Embodiment for 1.e and 1.f

ph_scaling_list_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the scaling list APS.

,

:

-   -   The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal         to SCALING_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to         ph_scaling_list_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the         TemporalId of the picture associated with PH.

. . .

ph_lmcs_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the LMCS APS that the slices associated with the PH refers to.

,

:

-   -   The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal         to LMCS_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to         ph_lmcs_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of         the picture associated with PH.

. . .

ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slices associate with the PH refers to.

,

:

-   -   The value of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit         having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and         adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall         be equal to 1.     -   The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal         to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to         ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be less than or equal to the         TemporalId of the picture associated with the PH.

ph_alf_chroma_idc equal to 0 specifies that the adaptive loop filter is not applied to Cb and Cr colour components. ph_alf_chroma_idc equal to 1 indicates that the adaptive loop filter is applied to the Cb colour component. ph_alf_chroma_idc equal to 2 indicates that the adaptive loop filter is applied to the Cr colour component. ph_alf_chroma_idc equal to 3 indicates that the adaptive loop filter is applied to Cb and Cr colour components. When ph_alf_chroma_idc is not present, it is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_alf_aps_id_chroma specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the chroma component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

,

:

-   -   The value of alf_chroma_filter_signal flag of the APS NAL unit         having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and         adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_chroma shall         be equal to 1.     -   The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal         to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to         ph_alf_aps_id_chroma shall be less than or equal to the         TemporalId of the picture associated with the PH.

. . .

ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the Cb colour component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

,

:

-   -   The value of alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit         having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and         adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall         be equal to 1.     -   The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal         to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to         ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the         TemporalId of the picture associated with the PH.

. . .

ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the Cr colour component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

,

:

-   -   The value of alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit         having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and         adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall         be equal to 1.     -   The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal         to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to         ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the         TemporalId of the picture associated with the PH.

. . .

slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slice refers to. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is not present, the value of slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i].

,

:

-   -   The TemporalId the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to         ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to         slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be less than or equal to the         TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit.     -   The value of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit         having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and         adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i]         shall be equal to 1.

. . .

slice_alf_aps_id_chroma specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the chroma component of the slice refers to. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is not present, the value of slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_chroma.

,

:

-   -   The TemporalId of the AIPS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal         to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to         slice_alf_aps_id_chroma shall be less than or equal to the         TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit.     -   The value of alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit         having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and         adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_chroma         shall be equal to 1.

. . .

slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id that the Cb colour component of the slice refers to.

When slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is not present, the value of slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id.

,

:

-   -   The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal         to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to         slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the         TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit.     -   The value of alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit         having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and         adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id         shall be equal to 1.

. . .

slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id that the Cr colour component of the slice refers to. When slice_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is not present, the value of slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id.

,

:

-   -   The TemporalId of the APS having aps_params_type equal to         ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to         slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the         TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit.     -   The value of alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit         having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and         adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id         shall be equal to 1.

. . .

6.1.11. An Embodiment for 1.g

The semantics of SH syntax elements are changes as follows:

slice_alf_aps_id_chroma specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the chroma component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_chroma shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is not present and

, the value of slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_chroma.

. . .

slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id that the Cb colour component of the slice refers to.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is not present and ChromaArrayType is not equal to 0, the value of slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id.

. . .

slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id that the Cr colour component of the slice refers to.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be less tan or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is not present and ChromaArrayType is not equal to 0, the value of slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id.

. . .

6.2. Second Set of Embodiments

This is a set of embodiments for items 2 (from 2.a to 2.c) summarized above in Section 5.

The syntax structure pic_parameter_set_rbsp( ) is changed as follows:

Descriptor pic_parameter_set_rbsp( ) {   pps_pic_parameter_set_id ue(v)  . . .   deblocking_filter_[ [ control_present_flag] ] mode _idc u([[1]] 2 )   if(deblocking_filter_[[control_present_flag]] mode _idc > 1 ) {     [ [ deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag] ] [[u(1)]]     [ [ pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag] ] [[u(1)]]    [[if( !pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag ) { }]     pps_beta_offset_div2 se(v)     pps_tc_offset_div2 se(v)     pps_cb_beta_offset_div2 se(v)     pps_cb_tc_offset_div2 se(v)     pps_cr_beta_offset_div2 se(v)     pps_cr_tc_offset_div2 se(v)     [ [ } ] ]   }    [ [ rpl_info_in_ph_flag] ] [[u(1)]]   if( deblocking_filter_[[override_enabled_ flag]] mode _idc = = 3 )    dbf_info_in_ph_flag u(1)    rpl _info_in_ph_flag  . . . . . .

,

,

,

,

.

dbf_info_in_ph_flag equal to 1 specifies that deblocking filter information is present in the PH syntax structure and not present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure. dbf_info_in_ph_flag equal to 0 specifies that deblocking filter information is not present in the PH syntax structure and may be present in slice headers referring to the PPS that do not contain a PH syntax structure.

. . .

And the syntax structure picture_header_structure( ) is changed as follows:

Descriptor picture_header_structure( ) {   gdr_or_irap_pic_flag u(1) . . .    if( deblocking_filter_[[override_enabled_flag]] mode _idc = = 3 && dbf_info_in_ph_flag) {     ph_deblocking_filter_[ [ override ] ] used _flag u(1)     if( ph_deblocking_filter_[[override]] used _flag ) {   ph_deblocking_[ [ filter_disabled] ] parameters _ u(1) override _flag      if( [[!]]ph_deblocking_[[filter_disabled]] parameters _override_flag ) {       ph_beta_offset_div2 se(v)       ph_tc_offset_div2 se(v)       ph_cb_beta_offset_div2 se(v)       ph_cb_tc_offset_div2 se(v)       ph_cr_beta_offset_div2 se(v)       ph_cr_tc_offset_div2 se(v)     }    }   } . . .

,

.

,

.

ph_deblocking_

_override_flag equal to 1 specifies that deblocking parameters are present in the PH. ph_deblocking_

_override_flag equal to 0 specifies that deblocking parameters are not present in the PH. When not present, the value of ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

. . .

And the syntax structure slice-header ( ) is changed as follows:

Descriptor slice_header( ) {   picture_header_in_slice_header_flag u(1) . . .    if( deblocking_filter_[[override_enabled_flag]] mode _idc = =&& !dbf_info_in_ph flag )     slice_deblocking_fiter[ [ override ] ] used _flag u(1)    if( slice_deblocking_filter_[[override]]_flag ) {     slice_deblocking_[ [ filter_disabled] ] parameters _ u(1) override _flag   if([[!]]slice_deblocking_[[filter_disabled]] parameters _ override _flag ) {      slice_beta_offset_div2 se(v)      slice_tc_offset_div2 se(v)      slice_cb_beta_offset_div2 se(v)      slice_cb_tc_offset_div2 se(v)      slice_cr_beta_offset_div2 se(v)      slice_cr_tc_offset_div2 se(v)     }    }  . . . . . .

,

.

.

slice_deblocking_

_override_flag equal to 1 specifies that deblocking parameters are present in the slice header. slice_deblocking_

_override_flag equal to 0 specifies that deblocking parameters are not present in the slice header. When not present, the value of slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag is inferred to be equal to

.

. . .

And the decoding process of deblocking filter process is changed as follows:

8.8.3 Deblocking Filter Process 8.8.3.1 General

The deblocking filter process is applied to all coding subblock edges and transform block edges of a picture, except the following types of edges:

-   -   Edges that are at the boundary of the picture,     -   Edges that coincide with the boundaries of a subpicture with         subpicture index subpicIdx and         loop_filter_across_subpic_enabled_flag[subpicIdx] is equal to 0,     -   Edges that coincide with the virtual boundaries of the picture         when VirtualBoundariesPresentFlag is equal to 1,     -   Edges that coincide with tile boundaries when         loop_filter_across_tiles_enabled_flag is equal to 0,     -   Edges that coincide with slice boundaries when         loop_filter_across_slices_enabled_flag is equal to 0,     -   Edges that coincide with upper or left boundaries of slices with         slice_deblocking_filter_         _flag equal to         ,     -   Edges within slices with slice_deblocking_filter_         _flag equal to         ,     -   Edges that do not correspond to 4×4 sample grid boundaries of         the luma component,     -   Edges that do not correspond to 8×8 sample grid boundaries of         the chroma component,     -   Edges within the luma component for which both sides of the edge         have intra_bdpcm_luma_flag equal to 1,     -   Edges within the chroma components for which both sides of the         edge have intra_bdpcm_chroma_flag equal to 1,     -   Edges of chroma subblocks that are not edges of the associated         transform unit.

The edge type, vertical or horizontal, is represented by the variable edgeType as specified in Table 42.

Table 42—Name of Association to edgeType

TABLE 42 Name of association to edgeType edgeType Name of edgeType 0 (vertical edge) EDGE_VER 1 (horizontal edge) EDGE_HOR

When slice_deblocking_filter_

_flag of the current slice is equal to

, the following applies:

-   -   The variable treeType is set equal to DUAL_TREE_LUMA.     -   The vertical edges are filtered by invoking the deblocking         filter process for one direction as specified in clause 8.8.3.2         with the variable treeType, the reconstructed picture prior to         deblocking, i.e., the array recPicture_(L) and the variable         edgeType set equal to EDGE_VER as inputs, and the modified         reconstructed picture after deblocking, i.e., the array         recPicture_(L) as outputs.     -   The horizontal edge are filtered by invoking the deblocking         filter process for one direction as specified in clause 8.8.3.2         with the variable treeType, the modified reconstructed picture         after deblocking, i.e., the array recPicture_(L) and the         variable edgeType set equal to EDGE_HOR as inputs, and the         modified reconstructed picture after deblocking, i.e., the array         recPicture_(L) as outputs.     -   When ChromaArrayType is not equal to 0, the following applies:         -   The variable treeType is set equal to DUAL_TREE_CHROMA         -   The vertical edges are filtered by invoking the deblocking             filter process for one direction as specified in clause             8.8.3.2 with the variable treeType, the reconstructed             picture prior to deblocking, i.e., the arrays             recPicture_(Cb) and recPicture_(Cr), and the variable             edgeType set equal to EDGE_VER as inputs, and the modified             reconstructed picture after deblocking, i.e., the arrays             recPicture_(Cb) and recPicture_(Cr) as outputs.         -   The horizontal edge are filtered by invoking the deblocking             filter process for one direction as specified in clause             8.8.3.2 with the variable treeType, the modified             reconstructed picture after deblocking, i.e., the arrays             recPicture_(Cb) and recPicture_(Cr), and the variable             edgeType set equal to EDGE_HOR as inputs, and the modified             reconstructed picture after deblocking, i.e., the arrays             recPicture_(Cb) and recPicture_(Cr) as outputs.

6.3. Third Set of Embodiments

The changes, marked in bold and Italic, are based on JVET-Q2001-vE.

The i-th chroma QP mapping table ChromaQpTable[i] for i=0..numQpTables−1 is derived as follows:

qpInVal[ i ][ 0 ] = qp_table_start_minus26[ i ] + 26 qpOutVal[ i ][ 0 ] = qpInVal[ i ][ 0 ] for( j = 0; j <= num_points_in_qp_table_minus1[ i ]; j++ ) {  qpInVal[ i ][ j + 1 ] = qpInVal[ i ][ j ] + delta_qp_in_val_minus1[ i ][ j ] + 1  qpOutVal[ i ][ j + 1 ] = qpOutVal[ i ][ j ] + ( (delta_qp_in_val_minus1[ i ][ j ] + 1 )   {circumflex over ( )} delta_ap_diff_val[ i ][ j ] ) } ChromaQpTable[ i ][ qpInVal[ i ][ 0 ] ] = qpOutVal[ i ][ 0 ] for( k = qpInVal[ i ][ 0 ] − 1; k >= −QpBdOffset; k − − )  ChromaQpTable[ i ][ k ] = Clip3( −QpBdOffset, 63, ChromaQpTable[ i ][ k + 1 ] − 1 ) for( j = 0; j <= num_points_in_qp_table_minus1[ i ]; j++ ) {  sh = ( delta_qp_in_val_minus1[ i ][j ] + 1 ) >> 1  for( k = qpInVal[ i ][ j ] + 1, m = 1; k <= qpInval[ i ][ j + 1 ]; k++, m++ )   ChromaQpTable[ i ][ k ] = ChromaQpTable[ i ][ qpInVal[ i ][ j ] ] +    ( ( qpOutVal[ i ][j + 1] − qpOutVal[ i ][j ] ) * m + sh ) / ( delta_qp_in_val_minus1[ i ][j] + 1 ) } for( k = qpInVal[ i ][ num_points_in_qp_table_minus1[ i ] + 1 ] + 1; k <= 63; k++ )  ChromaQpTable[ i ][ k ] = Clip3( −QpBdOffset, 63, ChromaQpTable[ i ][ k − 1 ] + 1 )

When same_qp_table_for_chroma is equal to 1, ChromaQpTable[1][k] and ChromaQpTable[2][k] are set equal to ChromaQpTable[0][k] for k in the range of −QpBdOffset to 63, inclusive.

It is a requirement of bitstream conformance that the values of qpInVal[i][j] and qpOutVal[i][j] shall be in the range of −QpBdOffset to 63, inclusive for i in the range of 0 to numQpTables−1, inclusive, and j in the range of 0 to num_points_in_qp_table_minus1[i]+1, inclusive.

6.4. Fourth Embodiment

PPS semantics (based on the text in JVET-R0159-v2, excluding the SPS flag):

. . .

deblocking_filter_control_present_flag equal to 1 specifies the presence of deblocking filter control syntax elements in the PPS. deblocking_filter_control_present flag equal to 0 specifies the absence of deblocking filter control syntax elements in the PPS

,

.

deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag equal to 1 specifies the presence of ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag in the PHs referring to the PPS or slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag in the slice headers referring to the PPS. deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag equal to 0 specifies the absence of ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag in PHs referring to the PPS or slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag in slice headers referring to the PPS. When not present, the value of deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

.

.

. . .

The syntax structure picture_header_structure( ) is changed as follows:

Descriptor picture_header_structure( ) {   gdr_or_irap_pic_ flag u(1) . . .   if( deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag && dbf_info_in_ph flag ) {    ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag u(1)    if( ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag ) {     if( !pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag )      ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag u(1)     if( !ph_deblocking_filter_disabled flag ) {      ph_beta_offset_div2 se(v)      ph_tc_offset_div2 se(v)      ph_cb_beta_offset_div2 se(v)      ph_cb_tc_offset_div2 se(v)      ph_cr_beta_offset_div2 se(v)      ph_cr_tc_offset_div2 se(v)     }    }   }  . . . . . .

ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag equal to 1 specifies that deblocking parameters are present in the PH. ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag equal to 0 specifies that deblocking parameters are not present in the PH. When not present, the value of ph_deblocking_filter_override_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.

ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that the operation of the deblocking filter is not applied for the slices associated with the PH. ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the operation of the deblocking filter is applied for the slices associated with the PH When ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not present it is inferred as follows:

-   -   ,         ,         :         ,     -   ,         to be equal to pps_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag.

. . .

And the syntax structure slice_header ( ) is changed as follows:

Descriptor slice_header( ) {  picture_header_in_slice_header_flag u(1) . . .  if( deblocking_filter_override_enabled_flag && !dbf_info_in_ph_flag )   slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag u(1)  if( slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag ) {    if( !pps _deblocking_filter_override_flag )    slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag u(1)   if( !slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag ) {    slice_beta_offset_div2 se(v)    slice_tc_offset_div2 se(v)    slice_cb_beta_offset_div2 se(v)    slice_cb_tc_offset_div2 se(v)    slice_cr_beta_offset_div2 se(v)    slice_cr_tc_offset_div2 se(v)   }  } . . .

. . .

slice_deblocking_fllter_override_flag equal to 1 specifies that deblocking parameters are present in the slice header. slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag equal to 0 specifies that deblocking parameters are not present in the slice header. When not present, the value of slice_deblocking_filter_override_flag is inferred to be equal to

.

slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag equal to 1 specifies that the operation of the deblocking filter is not applied for the current slice. slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag equal to 0 specifies that the operation of the deblocking filter is applied for the current slice.

When slice_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag is not present, it is inferred as follows:

-   -   ,         ,         :         ,     -   ,         to be equal to ph_deblocking_filter_disabled_flag.

6.5. Fifth Embodiment

The changes marked in bold and Italic are based on JVET-P2001-vE.

Descriptor coding_unit( x0, y0, cbWidth, cbHeight, cqtDepth, treeType, modeType ) {  chType = treeType = = DUAL_TREE_CHROMA ? 1 : 0  if( slice_type != I | | ( sps_ibc_enabled_flag && cbWidth <= 64 &&cbHeight <= 64 ) ) {   if( treeType != DUAL_TREE_CHROMA &&     ( ( !( cbWidth = = 4 && cbHeight = = 4 ) &&     modeType != MODE_TYPE_INTRA ) | |     ( sps_ibc_enabled_flag && cbWidth <= 64 && cbHeight <= 64 ) ) )    cu_skip_flag[ x0 ][ y0 ] ae(v)   if( cu_skip_flag[ x0 ][ y0 ] = = 0 && slice type != I &&     !( cbWidth = = 4 && cbHeight = = 4 ) && modeType = = MODE_TYPE_ALL )    pred_mode_flag ae(v)   if( ( ( slice type = = I && cu_skip_flag[ x0 ][ y0 ] = =0 ) | |     ( slice type != I && ( CuPredMode[ chType ][ x0 ][y0 ] != MODE_INTRA ||     ( ( ( cbWidth = = 4 && cbHeight = = 4 ) | | modeType = = MODE_TYPE_INTRA )      && cu_skip_flag[x0][y0] = = 0 ) ) ) ) &&     cbWidth <= 64 && cbHeight <= 64 && modeType != MODE_TYPE_INTER &&     sps_ibc_enabled_flag && treeType != DUAL_TREE_CHROMA )    pred_mode_ibc_flag ae(v)  } . . . }

6.6. Sixth Embodiment 7.3.2.5 Adaptation Parameter Set RBSP Syntax

Descriptor adaptation_parameter_set_rbsp( ) {  adaptation_parameter_set_id u(5)  aps_params_type u(3)   aps _chroma_params_present_flag u(1)  if( aps_params_type = = ALF_APS )   alf_data( )  else if( aps_params_type = = LMCS_APS )   lmcs_data( )  else if( aps_params_type = = SCALING_APS )   scaling_list_data( )  aps_extension_flag u(1)  if( aps_extension_flag )   while( more_rbsp_data( ) )    aps_extension_data_flag u(1)  rbsp_trailing_bits( ) }

,

.

7.3.2.19 Adaptive Loop Filter Data Syntax

Descriptor alf_data( ) {  alf_luma_filter_signal_flag u(1)   if( aps _chroma_params_present_flag ) {   alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag u(1)   alf_cc_cb_filter_signal flag u(1)   alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag u(1)   } . . . 7.3.2.20 Luma Mapping with Chroma Scaling Data Syntax

Descriptor lmcs_data( ) {  lmcs_min_bin_idx ue(v)  lmcs_delta_max_bin_idx ue(v)  lmcs_delta_cw_prec_minus1 ue(v)  for( i = lmcs_min_bin_idx; i <= LmcsMaxBinIdx; i++ ) {   lmcs_delta_abs_cw[ i ] u(v)   if( lmcs_delta_abs_cw[ i ] > 0 )    lmcs_delta_sign_cw_flag[ i ] u(1)  }  if( aps_chroma_params_present_flag )   lmcs_delta_abs_crs u(3)  if( lmcs_delta_abs_crs > 0 )   lmcs_delta_sign_crs_flag u(1) }

7.3.2.21 Scaling List Data Syntax

Descriptor scaling_list_data( ) {   scaling_matrix_for_lfnst_disabled_flag u(1)  [ [ scaling_list_chroma_present_flag] ]   for( id = 0; id < 28; id ++ )    matrixSize = (id < 2 ) ? 2 : ( ( id < 8 ) ? 4 : 8 )    if( aps _chroma_params_present_flag[[scaling_list_chroma_present flag]] | | ( id % 3 = = 2 ) | | (id = = 27 ) ) {     scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[ id ] u(1)     if( !scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[ id ] )      scaling_list_pred_mode_flag[ id ] u(1)     if( ( scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[ id ] | | scaling_list_pred_mode_flag[ id ] ) &&       id != 0 && id != 2 && id != 8 )      scaling_list_pred_id_delta[ id ] ue(v)     if( !scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[ id ] ) {      nextCoef = 0      if( id > 13 ) {       scaling_list_dc_coef[ id − 14 ] se(v)       nextCoef += scaling_list_dc_coef[ id − 14 ]      }      for( i = 0; i < matrixSize * matrixSize; i++ ) {       x = DiagScanOrder[ 3 ][ 3 ][ i ][ 0 ]       y = DiagScanOrder[ 3 ][ 3 ][ i ][ 1 ]       if( !( id > 25 && x >= 4 && y >= 4 ) ) {        scaling_list_delta_coef[ id ][ i ] se(v)        nextCoef += scaling_list_delta_coef[ id ][ i ]       }       ScalingList[ id ][ i ] = nextCoef      }     }    }   } }

And the PH semantics are changed as follows:

. . .

ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

The value of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be equal to 1.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] a shall be less than equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with the PH.

,

.

. . .

ph_lmcs_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the LMCS APS that the slices associated with the PH refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to LMCS_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_lmcs_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with PH.

,

.

. . .

ph_scaling_list_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the scaling list APS. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to SCALING_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_scaling_list_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with PH.

.

And the PH semantics are changed as follows:

slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is not present, the value of slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i].

The value of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be equal to 1.

,

.

. . .

And the ALF data semantics are changed as follows:

. . .

alf_luma_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that a luma filter set is signalled. alf_luma_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that a luma filter set is not signalled.

alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that a chroma filter is signalled. alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that a chroma filter is not signalled.

,

.

alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cb colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for Cb colour component are not signalled.

,

.

alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are not signalled.

,

.

. . .

And the SCALING data semantics are changed as follows:

. . .

. . .

6.7. Seventh Embodiment 7.3.2.6 Adaptation Parameter Set RBSP Syntax

Descriptor adaptation_parameter_set_rbsp( ) {  adaptation_parameter_set_id u(5)  aps_params_type u(3)   aps _chroma_params_present_flag u(1)  if( aps_params_type = = ALF_APS )   alf_data( )  else if( aps_params_type = = LMCS_APS )   lmcs_data( )  else if( aps_params_type = = SCALING_APS )   scaling_list_data( )  aps_extension_flag u(1)  if( aps_extension_flag )   while( more_rbsp_data( ) )    aps_extension_data_flag u(1)  rbsp_trailing_bits( ) }

,

.

7.3.2.19 Adaptive Loop Filter Data Syntax

Descriptor   alf_data( ) {   alf_luma_filter_signal_flag u(1)   if( aps_chroma_params_present_flag ) {    alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag u(1)    alf_cc_cb_filter_signal flag u(1)  if(alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag | | alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag)     alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag u(1)    } . . . 7.3.2.20 Luma Mapping with Chroma Scaling Data Syntax

Descriptor lmcs_data( ) {   lmcs_min_bin_idx ue(v)   lmcs_delta_max_bin_idx ue(v)   lmcs_delta_cw_prec_minus1 ue(v)   for( i = lmcs_min_bin_idx; i <= LmcsMaxBinIdx; i++ ) {   lmcs_delta_abs_cw[ i ] u(v)   if( lmcs_delta_abs_cw[ i ] > 0 )    lmcs_delta_sign_cw_flag[ i ] u(1)  }  if( aps _chroma_params_present_flag )   lmcs _delta_abs_crs_minus1 u(3) or u(v)  if( lmcs_delta_abs_crs > 0 )   lmcs_delta_sign_crs_flag u(1) }

7.3.2.21 Scaling List Data Syntax

Descriptor scaling_list_data( ) {   scaling_matrix_for_lfnst_disabled_flag u(1)   [ [ scaling_list_chroma_present_flag ] ]   for( id = 0; id < 28; id ++ )    matrixSize = (id < 2) ? 2 : ( ( id < 8 ) ? 4 : 8 )    if( aps _chroma_params_present_flag[[scaling_list_chroma_present flag]] | | (id % 3 = = 2 ) | | (id = = 27 ) ) {     scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[ id ] u(1)     if( !scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[ id ] )      scaling_list_pred_mode_flag[ id ] u(1)     if( ( scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[ id ] | | scaling_list_pred_mode_flag[ id ]) &&       id != 0 && id != 2 && id != 8 )      scaling_list_pred_id_delta[ id ] ue(v)     if( !scaling_list_copy_mode_flag[ id ] ) {      nextCoef = 0      if( id > 13 ) {       scaling_list_dc_coef[ id − 14 ] se(v)       nextCoef += scaling_list_dc_coef[ id − 14 ]      }      for( i = 0; i < matrixSize * matrixSize; i++ ) {       x = DiagScanOrder[ 3 ][ 3 ][ i ][ 0 ]       y = DiagScanOrder[ 3 ][ 3 ][ i ][ 1 ]       if( !( id > 25 && x >= 4 && y >= 4 ) ) {        scaling_list_delta_coef[ id ] [i ] se(v)        nextCoef += scaling_list_delta_coef[ id ][ i ]       }       ScalingList[ id ][ i ] = nextCoef      }     }    }   } }

Semantics changes:

specifies the absolute codeword value of the variable lmcsDeltaCrs. The value of

shall be in the range of 0 and 7, inclusive. When not present,

.

And the PH semantics are changed as follows:

. . .

ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

The value of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be equal to 1.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with the PH.

,

.

. . .

ph_lmcs_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the LMCS APS that the slices associated with the PH refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to LMCS_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_lmcs_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with PH.

,

.

. . .

ph_scaling_list_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the scaling list APS. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to SCALING_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to ph_scaling_list_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the picture associated with PH.

.

And the PH semantics are changed as follows:

slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is not present, the value of slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i].

The value of alf_luma_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be equal to 1.

,

.

. . .

And the ALF data semantics are changed as follows:

. . .

alf_luma_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that a luma filter set is signalled. alf_luma_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that a luma filter set is not signalled.

alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that a chroma filter is signalled. alf_chroma_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that a chroma filter is not signaled.

,

.

alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cb colour component are signalled, alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for Cb colour component are not signalled.

,

.

alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 1 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are signalled. alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag equal to 0 specifies that cross-component filters for the Cr colour component are not signalled.

,

.

. . .

And the SCALING data semantics are changed as follows:

. . .

. . .

6.8. Eighth Embodiment 7.3.2.5 Adaptation Parameter Set RBSP Syntax

Descriptor adaptation_parameter_set_rbsp( ) {   [ [ adaptation_parameter_set_id] ] [[u(5)]]  aps_params_type u(3)  if( aps_params_type = = ALF_APS ) {    adaptation _parameer_set_id u(9)   alf_data( )   } else if( aps_params_type = = LMCS_APS )    adaptation _parameter_set_id u(2)   lmcs_data( )   } else if( aps_params_type = = SCALING_APS )    adaptation _parameter_set_id u(3)   scaling_list_data( )   }  aps_extension_flag u(1)  if( aps_extension_flag)   while( more_rbsp_data( ) )    aps_extension_data_flag u(1)   rbsp_trailing_bits( ) }

7.3.2.7 Picture Header Structure Syntax

Descriptor picture_header_structure( ) { . . .  if( sps_alf_enabled_flag && alf_info_in_ph_flag ) {   ph_alf_enabled_flag u(1)   if( ph_alf_enabled_flag ) {    ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma u e ( v [[3]])    for( i = 0; i < ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma; i++ )     ph_alf_aps_id_luma[ i ] u e ( v [[3]])    if( ChromaArrayType != 0 )     ph_alf_chroma_idc u(2)    if( ph_alf_chroma_idc > 0 )     ph_alf_aps_id_chroma u e ( v [[3]])    if( sps_ccalf_enabled_flag ) {     ph_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag u(1)     if( ph_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag)      ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id u e ( v [[3]])     ph_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag u(1)     if( ph_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag)      ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id u e ( v [[3]])    }   }  } . . .

7.3.7.1 General Slice Header Syntax

Descriptor slice_header( ) { . . .  if( sps_alf_enabled_flag && !alf_info_in_ph flag ) {   slice_alf_enabled_flag u(1)   if( slice_alf_enabled_flag ) {    slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma u e(v [ [ 3 ] ])    for( i = 0; i < slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma; i++ )     slice_alf_aps_id_luma[ i ] u e(v [ [ 3 ] ])    if( ChromaArrayType != 0 )     slice_alf_chroma_idc u(2)    if( slice_alf_chroma_idc )     slice_alf_aps_id_chroma u e(v [ [ 3 ] ])    if( sps_ccalf_enabled_flag ) {     slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag u(1)     if( slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag )      slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id u e(v [ [ 3 ] ])     slice_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag u(1)     if( slice_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag )      slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id u e(v [ [ 3 ] ])    }   }  } . . .

7.4.3.5 Adaptation Parameter Set Semantics

Each APS RBSP shall be available to the decoding process prior to it being referenced, included in at least one AU with TemporalId less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit that refers it or provided through external means.

All APS NAL units with a particular value of adaptation_parameter_set_id and a particular value of aps_params_type within a PU, regardless of whether they are prefix or suffix APS NAL units, shall have the same content.

adaptation_parameter_set_id provides an identifier for the APS for reference by other syntax elements.

When aps_params_type is equal to ALF_APS, the value of adaptation_parameter_set_id shall be in range of 0 to 246, inclusive.

,

,

.

When aps_params_type is equal to LMCS_APS the value of adaptation_parameter_set_id shall be in the range of 0 to 3, inclusive.

Let apsLayerId be the value of the nuh_layer_id of a particular APS NAL unit, and vclLayerId be the value of the nuh_layer_id of a particular VCL NAL unit. The particular VCL NAL unit shall not refer to the particular APS NAL unit unless apsLayerId is less than or equal to vclLayerId and the layer with nuh_layer_id equal to apsLayerId is included in at least one OLS that includes the layer with nuh_layer_id equal to vclLayerId.

aps_params_type specifies the type of APS parameters carried in the APS as specified in Table 6.

. . .

,

,

.

All APS NAL units with a particular value of aps_params_type, regardless of the nuh_layer_id values, share the same value space for adaptation_parameter_set_id. APS NAL units with different values of aps_params_type use separate values spaces for adaptation_parameter_set_id.

7.4.3.7 Picture Header Structure Semantics

ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma specifies the number of ALF APSs that the slices associated with the PH refers to.

,

.

ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

,

.

ph_alf_aps_id_chroma specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the chroma component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

,

.

ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the Cb colour component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

,

.

ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the Cr colour component of the slices associated with the PH refers to.

327, inclusive.

. . .

7.4.8.1 General Slice Header Semantics

slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma specifies the number of ALF APSs that the slice refers to. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma is not present, the value of slice_num_alf_aps_ids_luma[i] is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_num_alf_aps_ids_luma.

,

.

slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the i-th ALF APS that the luma component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is not present, the value of slice_alf_aps_id_luma[i] is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_luma[i].

,

slice_alf_aps_id_chroma specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id of the ALF APS that the chroma component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_alf_aps_id_chroma shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_alf_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is not present, the value of slice_alf_aps_id_chroma is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_alf_aps_id_chroma.

,

.

slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id that the Cb colour component of the slice refers to.

The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_cc_alf_cb_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is not present, the value of slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_cc_alf_cb_aps_id.

,

.

The value of alf_cc_cb_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cb_aps_id shall be equal to 1.

slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id specifies the adaptation_parameter_set_id that the Cr colour component of the slice refers to. The TemporalId of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be less than or equal to the TemporalId of the coded slice NAL unit. When slice_cc_alf_cr_enabled_flag is equal to 1 and slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is not present, the value of slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id is inferred to be equal to the value of ph_cc_alf_cr_aps_id.

,

.

The value of alf_cc_cr_filter_signal_flag of the APS NAL unit having aps_params_type equal to ALF_APS and adaptation_parameter_set_id equal to slice_cc_alf_cr_aps_id shall be equal to 1.

6.9. Ninth Embodiment 7.3.2.5 Adaptation Parameter Set RBSP Syntax

Descriptor adaptation_parameter_set_rbsp( ) {   [ [ adaptation_parameter_set_id] ] [[u(5)]]  aps_params_type u(3)  if( aps_params_type = = ALF_APS ) {    adaptation _parameter_set_id ue(v)   alf_data( )  } else if( aps_params_type = = LMCS_APS ) {    adaptation _parameter_set_id u(2)   lmcs_data( )  } else if( aps_params_type = = SCALING_APS ) {    adaptation _parameter_set_id u(3)   scaling_list_data( )  }  aps_extension_flag u(1)  if( aps_extension_flag)   while( more_rbsp_data( ) )    aps_extension_data_flag u(1)   rbsp_trailing_bits( ) }

6.10. Tenth Embodiment

Descriptor adaptation_parameter_set_rbsp( ) {  adaptation_parameter_set_id u e ([[5]] v )  aps_params_type u(3)  if( aps_params_type = = ALF_APS )   alf_data( )  else if( aps_params_type = = LMCS_APS )   lmcs_data( )  else if( aps_params_type = = SCALING_APS )   scaling_list_data( )  aps_extension_flag u(1)  if( aps_extension_flag)   while( more_rbsp_data( ) )    aps_extension_data_flag u(1)  rbsp_trailing_bits( ) }

6.11. Eleventh Embodiment

In one example, the PH syntax table is changed as follows:

Descriptor picture_header_structure( ) { . . .   if( sps_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag ) {    ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag u(1)    if( ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag && rpl_info_in_ph_flag ) {     if( num _ref_entries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx[ 1 ] ] > 0 )      ph_collocated_from_l0_flag u(1)     if( ( ph_collocated_from_l0_flag &&        num_ref_entries[ 0 ][ RplsIdx[ 0 ] ] > 1 ) | |        ( !ph_collocated_from_10_flag &&        num_ref_entries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx[ l ] ] > 1 ) )       ph_collocated_ref_idx ue(v)    }  }    if( !rpl _info_in_ph_flag | | number_ref_enteries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx [ 1 ] ] > 0 )    mvd_l1_zero_flag u(1)   if( sps_fpel_mmvd_enabled_flag)    ph_fpel_mmvd_enabled_flag u(1)    if( !rpl _info_in_ph_flag | | number_ref_enteries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx [ 1 ] ] > 0 ) {    if( sps_bdof_pic_present_flag )     ph_disable_bdof_flag u(1)    if( sps_dmvr_pic_present_flag )     ph_disabled_mvr_flag u(1)    }   if( sps_prof_pic_present_flag )    ph_disable_prof_flag u(1)   if( (pps_weighted_pred flag || pps_weighted_bipred_flag ) && wp_info_in_ph_flag )    pred_weight_table( ) . . .

And the semantics are changes as follows:

. . .

ph_collocated_from_l0_flag equal to 1 specifies that the collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference picture list 0. ph_collocated_from_l0_flag equal to 0 specifies that the collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference picture list 1.

.

. . .

mvd_l1_zero_flag equal to 1 indicates that the mvd_coding(x0, y0, 1) syntax structure is not parsed and MvdL1[x0][y0][compIdx] and MvdCpL1[x0][y0][cpIdx][compIdx] are set equal to 0 for compIdx=0..1 and cpIdx=0..2. mvd_l1_zero_flag equal to 0 indicates that the mvd_coding(x0, y0, 1) syntax structure is parsed.

.

. . .

ph_disable_bdof_flag equal to 1 specifies that bi-directional optical flow inter prediction based inter bi-prediction is disabled in the slices associated with the PH. ph_disable_bdof_flag equal to 0 specifies that bi-directional optical flow inter prediction based inter bi-prediction may or may not be enabled in the slices associated with the PH.

When ph_disable_bdof_flag is not present the following applies:

-   -   ,         .     -   ,         f sps_bdof_enabled_flag is equal to 1, the value of         ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.     -   Otherwise (sps_bdof_enabled_flag is equal to 0), the value of         ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be equal to 1.

ph_disable_dmvr_flag equal to 1 specifies that decoder motion vector refinement based inter bi-prediction is disabled in the slices associated with the PH. ph_disable_dmvr_flag equal to 0 specifies that decoder motion vector refinement based inter bi-prediction may or may not be enabled in the slices associated with the PH.

When ph_disable_dmvr_flag is not present, the following applies.

-   -   ,         .     -   ,         f sps_dmvr_enabled_flag is equal to 1, the value of         ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be equal to 0.     -   Otherwise (sps_dmvr_enabled_flag is equal to 0), the value of         ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be equal to 1.

. . .

And the syntax table pred_weight_table( ) is changed as follows:

Descriptor pred_weight_table( ) { . . .  if( pps_weighted_bipred_flag && wp_info_in_ph_flag && if( !rpl _info_in_ph_flag | | numr_ref_enteries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx [ 1 ] ] > 0 ) )   num_l1_weights ue(v) . . .

And the semantics of num_l1_weights are changed as follows:

num_l1_weights specifies the number of weights signalled for entries in reference picture list 1 when pps_weighted_bipred_flag and wp_info_in_ph_flag are both equal to 1. The value of num_l1_weights shall be in the range of 0 to Min(15, num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]), inclusive.

The variable NumWeightsL1 is derived as follows:

if( !pps_weighted_bipred_flag )  NumWeightsL1 = 0 else if (wp _info_in_ph_flag && rpl_info_in_ph_flag && num_ref_entries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx[ 1 ] ] == 0 )   NumWeightL1 = 0 else if( wp_info_in_ph_flag)   NumWeightsL1 = num_l1_weights else  NumWeightsL1 = NumRefIdx Active[ 1 ]

6.12. Twelfth Embodiment

In one example, the PH syntax table is changed as follows:

Descriptor picture_header_structure( ) { . . .   if( sps_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag) {    ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag u(1)    if( ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag && rpl_info_in_ph_flag ) {     if( num _ref_enteries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx[ 1 ] ] > 0 )      ph_collocated_from_l0_flag u(1)     if( ( ph_collocated_from_l0_flag &&        num_ref_entries[ 0 ][ RplsIdx[ 0 ] ] > 1 ) | |        ( !ph_collocated_from_l0_flag &&        num_ref_entries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx[ l ] ] > 1 ) )       ph_collocated_ref_idx ue(v)    }  }    [ [ mvd_l1_zero_flag] ] [[u(1)]]   if( sps_fpel_mmvd_enabled_flag )    ph_fpel_mmvd_enabled_flag u(1)    if( !rpl _info_in_ph_flag | | num_ref_enteries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx[ 1 ] ] > 0 ) {     mvd _l1_zero_flag u(1)    if( sps_bdof_pic_present_flag)     ph_disable_bdof_flag u(1)    if( sps_dmvr_pic_present_flag)     ph_disabled_mvr_flag u(1)    }   if( sps_prof_pic_present_flag)    ph_disable_prof_flag u(1)   if( (pps_weighted_pred_flag | | pps_weighted_bipred_flag ) && wp_info_in_ph_flag )    pred_weight_table( ) . . .

And the semantics are changes as follows:

. . .

ph_collocated_from_l0_flag equal to 1 specifies that the collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference picture list 0. ph_collocated_from_l0_flag equal to 0 specifies that the collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference picture list 1.

,

.

. . .

mvd_l1_zero_flag equal to 1 specifies that the mvd_coding(x0, y0, 1) syntax structure is not parsed and MvdL1[x0][y0][compIdx] and MvdCpL1[x0][y0][cpIdx][compIdx] are set equal to 0 for compIdx=0..1 and cpIdx=0..2. mvd_l1_zero_flag equal to 0 specifies that the mvd_coding(x0, y0, 1) syntax structure is parsed.

,

.

. . .

ph_disable_bdof_flag equal to 1 specifies that bi-directional optical flow inter prediction based inter bi-prediction is disabled in the slices associated with the PH. ph_disable_bdof_flag equal to 0 specifies that bi-directional optical flow inter prediction based inter bi-prediction may or may not be enabled in the slices associated with the PH.

When ph_disable_bdof_flag is not present, the following applies:

-   -   If sps_bdof_enabled_flag         equal to 1         , the value of ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be equal to         0.     -   Otherwise, the value of ph_disable_bdof_flag is inferred to be         equal to 1.

ph_disable_dmvr_flag equal to 1 specifies that decoder motion vector refinement based inter bi-prediction is disabled in the slices associated with the PH. ph_disable_dmvr_flag equal to 0 specifies that decoder motion vector refinement based inter bi-prediction may or may not be enabled in the slices associated with the PH.

When ph_disable_dmvr_flag is not present, the following applies:

-   -   If sps_dmvr_enabled_flag         equal to 1         , the value of ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be equal to         0.     -   Otherwise, the value of ph_disable_dmvr_flag is inferred to be         equal to 1.

. . .

And the syntax table pred_weight_table( ) is changed as follows:

Descriptor pred_weight_table( ) { . . .  if( pps_weighted_bipred_flag && wp_info_in_ph_flag && num _ref_enteries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx[ 1 ] ] > 0 )   num_l1_weights ue(v) . . .

And the semantics of num_l1_weights are changed as follows:

num_l1_weights specifies the number of weights signalled for entries in reference picture list 1 when pps_weighted_bipred_flag and wp_info_in_ph_flag are both equal to 1. The value of num_l1_weights shall be in the range of 0 to Min(15, num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]), inclusive.

The variable NumWeightsL1 is derived as follows:

if(!pps_weighted_bipred_flag∥(

NumWeightsL1=0

else if(wp_info_in_ph_flag)

NumWeightsL1=num_l1_weights

else

NumWeightsL1=NumRefIdxActive[1]  (148)

6.13. Thirteen Embodiment

The following changes are proposed to address the above issue, wherein the added part are highlighted in bold and Italic.

Descriptor picture_header_structure( ) {  gdr_or_irap_pic_flag u(1)  if( gdr_or_irap_pic_flag )   gdr_pic_flag u(1)  ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag u(1)  if( ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag && !no _pic_partition_flag && !( rect_slice_flag && num _slices_in_pic_minus1 = = 0 ) )   ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag u(1) . . .

. . .

ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag equal to 0 specifies that all coded slices of the picture have slice_type equal to 0 or 1. ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag equal to 1 specifies that there may or may not be one or more coded slices in the picture that have slice_type equal to 2. When not present, the value of ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag is inferred to be equal to (1

.

Alternatively, the following applies:

. . .

ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag equal to 0 specifies that all coded slices of the picture have slice_type equal to 0 or 1. ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag equal to 1 specifies that there may or may not be one or more coded slices in the picture that have slice_type equal to 2. When not present, the value of ph_intra_slice_allowed_flag is inferred to be equal to

.

FIG. 1 is a block diagram showing an example video processing system 1900 in which various techniques disclosed herein may be implemented. Various implementations may include some or all of the components of the system 1900. The system 1900 may include input 1902 for receiving video content. The video content may be received in a raw or uncompressed format, e.g., 8 or 10 bit multi-component pixel values, or may be in a compressed or encoded format. The input 1902 may represent a network interface, a peripheral bus interface, or a storage interface. Examples of network interface include wired interfaces such as Ethernet, passive optical network (PON), etc. and wireless interfaces such as wireless fidelity (Wi-Fi) or cellular interfaces.

The system 1900 may include a coding component 1904 that may implement the various coding or encoding methods described in the present disclosure. The coding component 1904 may reduce the average bitrate of video from the input 1902 to the output of the coding component 1904 to produce a coded representation of the video. The coding techniques are therefore sometimes called video compression or video transcoding techniques. The output of the coding component 1904 may be either stored, or transmitted via a communication connected, as represented by the component 1906. The stored or communicated bitstream (or coded) representation of the video received at the input 1902 may be used by the component 1908 for generating pixel values or displayable video that is sent to a display interface 1910. The process of generating user-viewable video from the bitstream representation is sometimes called video decompression. Furthermore, while certain video processing operations are referred to as “coding” operations or tools, it will be appreciated that the coding tools or operations are used at an encoder and corresponding decoding tools or operations that reverse the results of the coding will be performed by a decoder.

Examples of a peripheral bus interface or a display interface may include universal serial bus (USB) or high definition multimedia interface (HDMI) or Displayport, and so on. Examples of storage interfaces include serial advanced technology attachment (SATA), peripheral component interconnect (PCI), integrated drive electronics (IDE) interface, and the like. The techniques described in the present disclosure may be embodied in various electronic devices such as mobile phones, laptops, smartphones or other devices that are capable of performing digital data processing and/or video display.

FIG. 2 is a block diagram of a video processing apparatus 3600. The apparatus 3600 may be used to implement one or more of the methods described herein. The apparatus 3600 may be embodied in a smartphone, tablet, computer, Internet of Things (IoT) receiver, and so on. The apparatus 3600 may include one or more processors 3602, one or more memories 3604 and video processing hardware 3606. The processor(s) 3602 may be configured to implement one or more methods described in the present disclosure. The memory (memories) 3604 may be used for storing data and code used for implementing the methods and techniques described herein. The video processing hardware 3606 may be used to implement, in hardware circuitry, some techniques described in the present disclosure.

FIG. 4 is a block diagram that illustrates an example video coding system 100 that may utilize the techniques of this disclosure.

As shown in FIG. 4 , video coding system 100 may include a source device 110 and a destination device 120. Source device 110 generates encoded video data which may be referred to as a video encoding device. Destination device 120 may decode the encoded video data generated by source device 110 which may be referred to as a video decoding device.

Source device 110 may include a video source 112, a video encoder 114, and an input/output (I/O) interface 116.

Video source 112 may include a source such as a video capture device, an interface to receive video data from a video content provider, and/or a computer graphics system for generating video data, or a combination of such sources. The video data may comprise one or more pictures. Video encoder 114 encodes the video data from video source 112 to generate a bitstream. The bitstream may include a sequence of bits that form a coded representation of the video data. The bitstream may include coded pictures and associated data. The coded picture is a coded representation of a picture. The associated data may include sequence parameter sets, picture parameter sets, and other syntax structures. I/O interface 116 may include a modulator/demodulator (modem) and/or a transmitter. The encoded video data may be transmitted directly to destination device 120 via I/O interface 116 through network 130 a. The encoded video data may also be stored onto a storage medium/server 130 b for access by destination device 120.

Destination device 120 may include an I/O interface 126, a video decoder 124, and a display device 122.

I/O interface 126 may include a receiver and/or a modem. I/O interface 126 may acquire encoded video data from the source device 110 or the storage medium/server 130 b. Video decoder 124 may decode the encoded video data. Display device 122 may display the decoded video data to a user. Display device 122 may be integrated with the destination device 120, or may be external to destination device 120 which be configured to interface with an external display device.

Video encoder 114 and video decoder 124 may operate according to a video compression standard, such as the High Efficiency Video Coding (HEVC) standard, Versatile Video Coding (VVC) standard and other current and/or further standards.

FIG. 5 is a block diagram illustrating an example of video encoder 200, which may be video encoder 114 in the system 100 illustrated in FIG. 4 .

Video encoder 200 may be configured to perform any or all of the techniques of this disclosure. In the example of FIG. 5 , video encoder 200 includes a plurality of functional components. The techniques described in this disclosure may be shared among the various components of video encoder 200. In some examples, a processor may be configured to perform any or all of the techniques described in this disclosure.

The functional components of video encoder 200 may include a partition unit 201, a prediction unit 202 which may include a mode select unit 203, a motion estimation unit 204, a motion compensation unit 205 and an intra prediction unit 206, a residual generation unit 207, a transform unit 208, a quantization unit 209, an inverse quantization unit 210, an inverse transform unit 211, a reconstruction unit 212, a buffer 213, and an entropy encoding unit 214.

In other examples, video encoder 200 may include more, fewer, or different functional components. In an example, prediction unit 202 may include an intra block copy (IBC) unit. The IBC unit may perform prediction in an IBC mode in which at least one reference picture is a picture where the current video block is located.

Furthermore, some components, such as motion estimation unit 204 and motion compensation unit 205 may be highly integrated, but are represented in the example of FIG. 5 separately for purposes of explanation.

Partition unit 201 may partition a picture into one or more video blocks. Video encoder 200 and video decoder 300 may support various video block sizes.

Mode select unit 203 may select one of the coding modes, intra or inter, e.g., based on error results, and provide the resulting intra- or inter-coded block to a residual generation unit 207 to generate residual block data and to a reconstruction unit 212 to reconstruct the encoded block for use as a reference picture. In some example, Mode select unit 203 may select a combination of intra and inter prediction (CIIP) mode in which the prediction is based on an inter prediction signal and an intra prediction signal. Mode select unit 203 may also select a resolution for a motion vector (e.g., a sub-pixel or integer pixel precision) for the block in the case of inter-prediction.

To perform inter prediction on a current video block, motion estimation unit 204 may generate motion information for the current video block by comparing one or more reference frames from buffer 213 to the current video block. Motion compensation unit 205 may determine a predicted video block for the current video block based on the motion information and decoded samples of pictures from buffer 213 other than the picture associated with the current video block.

Motion estimation unit 204 and motion compensation unit 205 may perform different operations for a current video block, for example, depending on whether the current video block is in an I slice, a P slice, or a B slice.

In some examples, motion estimation unit 204 may perform uni-directional prediction for the current video block, and motion estimation unit 204 may search reference pictures of list 0 or list 1 for a reference video block for the current video block. Motion estimation unit 204 may then generate a reference index that indicates the reference picture in list 0 or list 1 that contains the reference video block and a motion vector that indicates a spatial displacement between the current video block and the reference video block. Motion estimation unit 204 may output the reference index, a prediction direction indicator, and the motion vector as the motion information of the current video block. Motion compensation unit 205 may generate the predicted video block of the current block based on the reference video block indicated by the motion information of the current video block.

In other examples, motion estimation unit 204 may perform bi-directional prediction for the current video block, motion estimation unit 204 may search the reference pictures in list 0 for a reference video block for the current video block and may also search the reference pictures in list 1 for another reference video block for the current video block. Motion estimation unit 204 may then generate reference indexes that indicate the reference pictures in list 0 and list 1 containing the reference video blocks and motion vectors that indicate spatial displacements between the reference video blocks and the current video block. Motion estimation unit 204 may output the reference indexes and the motion vectors of the current video block as the motion information of the current video block. Motion compensation unit 205 may generate the predicted video block of the current video block based on the reference video blocks indicated by the motion information of the current video block.

In some examples, motion estimation unit 204 may output a full set of motion information for decoding processing of a decoder.

In some examples, motion estimation unit 204 may not output a full set of motion information for the current video. Rather, motion estimation unit 204 may signal the motion information of the current video block with reference to the motion information of another video block. For example, motion estimation unit 204 may determine that the motion information of the current video block is sufficiently similar to the motion information of a neighboring video block.

In one example, motion estimation unit 204 may indicate, in a syntax structure associated with the current video block, a value that indicates to the video decoder 300 that the current video block has the same motion information as another video block.

In another example, motion estimation unit 204 may identify, in a syntax structure associated with the current video block, another video block and a motion vector difference (MVD). The motion vector difference indicates a difference between the motion vector of the current video block and the motion vector of the indicated video block. The video decoder 300 may use the motion vector of the indicated video block and the motion vector difference to determine the motion vector of the current video block.

As discussed above, video encoder 200 may predictively signal the motion vector. Two examples of predictive signaling techniques that may be implemented by video encoder 200 include advanced motion vector prediction (AMVP) and merge mode signaling.

Intra prediction unit 206 may perform intra prediction on the current video block. When intra prediction unit 206 performs intra prediction on the current video block, intra prediction unit 206 may generate prediction data for the current video block based on decoded samples of other video blocks in the same picture. The prediction data for the current video block may include a predicted video block and various syntax elements.

Residual generation unit 207 may generate residual data for the current video block by subtracting (e.g., indicated by the minus sign) the predicted video block(s) of the current video block from the current video block. The residual data of the current video block may include residual video blocks that correspond to different sample components of the samples in the current video block.

In other examples, there may be no residual data for the current video block for the current video block, for example in a skip mode, and residual generation unit 207 may not perform the subtracting operation.

Transform processing unit 208 may generate one or more transform coefficient video blocks for the current video block by applying one or more transforms to a residual video block associated with the current video block.

After transform processing unit 208 generates a transform coefficient video block associated with the current video block, quantization unit 209 may quantize the transform coefficient video block associated with the current video block based on one or more quantization parameter (QP) values associated with the current video block.

Inverse quantization unit 210 and inverse transform unit 211 may apply inverse quantization and inverse transforms to the transform coefficient video block, respectively, to reconstruct a residual video block from the transform coefficient video block. Reconstruction unit 212 may add the reconstructed residual video block to corresponding samples from one or more predicted video blocks generated by the prediction unit 202 to produce a reconstructed video block associated with the current block for storage in the buffer 213.

After reconstruction unit 212 reconstructs the video block, loop filtering operation may be performed reduce video blocking artifacts in the video block.

Entropy encoding unit 214 may receive data from other functional components of the video encoder 200. When entropy encoding unit 214 receives the data, entropy encoding unit 214 may perform one or more entropy encoding operations to generate entropy encoded data and output a bitstream that includes the entropy encoded data.

FIG. 6 is a block diagram illustrating an example of video decoder 300 which may be video decoder 124 in the system 100 illustrated in FIG. 4 .

The video decoder 300 may be configured to perform any or all of the techniques of this disclosure. In the example of FIG. 6 , the video decoder 300 includes a plurality of functional components. The techniques described in this disclosure may be shared among the various components of the video decoder 300. In some examples, a processor may be configured to perform any or all of the techniques described in this disclosure.

In the example of FIG. 6 , video decoder 300 includes an entropy decoding unit 301, a motion compensation unit 302, an intra prediction unit 303, an inverse quantization unit 304, an inverse transformation unit 305, and a reconstruction unit 306 and a buffer 307. Video decoder 300 may, in some examples, perform a decoding pass generally reciprocal to the encoding pass described with respect to video encoder 200 (FIG. 5 ).

Entropy decoding unit 301 may retrieve an encoded bitstream. The encoded bitstream may include entropy coded video data (e.g., encoded blocks of video data). Entropy decoding unit 301 may decode the entropy coded video data, and from the entropy decoded video data, motion compensation unit 302 may determine motion information including motion vectors, motion vector precision, reference picture list indexes, and other motion information. Motion compensation unit 302 may, for example, determine such information by performing the AMVP and merge mode.

Motion compensation unit 302 may produce motion compensated blocks, possibly performing interpolation based on interpolation filters. Identifiers for interpolation filters to be used with sub-pixel precision may be included in the syntax elements.

Motion compensation unit 302 may use interpolation filters as used by video encoder 200 during encoding of the video block to calculate interpolated values for sub-integer pixels of a reference block. Motion compensation unit 302 may determine the interpolation filters used by video encoder 200 according to received syntax information and use the interpolation filters to produce predictive blocks.

Motion compensation unit 302 may use some of the syntax information to determine sizes of blocks used to encode frame(s) and/or slice(s) of the encoded video sequence, partition information that describes how each macroblock of a picture of the encoded video sequence is partitioned, modes indicating how each partition is encoded, one or more reference frames (and reference frame lists) for each inter-encoded block, and other information to decode the encoded video sequence.

Intra prediction unit 303 may use intra prediction modes for example received in the bitstream to form a prediction block from spatially adjacent blocks. Inverse quantization unit 303 inverse quantizes, i.e., de-quantizes, the quantized video block coefficients provided in the bitstream and decoded by entropy decoding unit 301. Inverse transform unit 303 applies an inverse transform.

Reconstruction unit 306 may sum the residual blocks with the corresponding prediction blocks generated by motion compensation unit 302 or intra-prediction unit 303 to form decoded blocks. If desired, a deblocking filter may also be applied to filter the decoded blocks in order to remove blockiness artifacts. The decoded video blocks are then stored in buffer 307, which provides reference blocks for subsequent motion compensation/intra prediction and also produces decoded video for presentation on a display device.

A listing of examples preferred by some embodiments is provided next.

The first set of clauses shows example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section. The following clauses show example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section (e.g., item 1).

1. A video processing method (e.g., method 3000 shown in FIG. 3 ), comprising: performing (3002) a conversion between a video having one or more chroma components, the video comprising one or more video pictures comprising one or more slices and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a chroma array type field controls a constraint on a conversion characteristic of chroma used during the conversion.

2. The method of clause 1, wherein the conversion characteristic includes a constraint on a field indicative of presence of one or more scaling lists for the one or more chroma components.

3. The method of clause 1, wherein the conversion characteristic includes a constraint on a value of a field indicative of a codeword used for signaling luma mapping with chroma scaling.

4. The method of clause 1, wherein the conversion characteristic includes a constraint on values of syntax elements describing an adaptation parameter set for an adaptive loop filter used during the conversion.

5. The method of clause 1, wherein the format rule specifies to use a same semantics of one or more entries of an adaptation parameter set for the chroma array type field signaling a 4:0:0 format or a separate color coding format.

6. The method of clause 5, wherein the one or more entries include an adaptive loop filter parameter or a scaling list parameter or a luma mapping with chroma scaling parameter.

7. The method of clauses 5-6, wherein the format rule further specifies that a constraint on the one or more entries of the adaptation parameter set is dependent on whether an identifier of the adaptation parameter set is included in the bitstream.

The following clauses show example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section (e.g., item 2).

8. A video processing method, comprising: performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures comprising one or more video regions and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule that specifies the include a deblocking mode indicator for a video region indicative of applicability of a deblocking filter to the video region during the conversion.

9. The method of clause 8, wherein the deblocking mode indicator is an N bit field where N is an integer greater than 1.

10. The method of any of clauses 8-9, wherein the deblocking mode indicator for the video region is included in a picture parameter set.

11. The method of clause 8, wherein the deblocking mode indicator corresponds to a flag included in a header of the video region indicating applicability of the deblocking filter to the video region.

12. The method of any of clauses 8-11, wherein the format rule specifies that a flag that signals whether deblocking filter parameters signaled in the deblocking mode indicator are to override default parameters.

13. The method of any of clauses 8-12, wherein the video region corresponds to a video picture or a video slice.

The following clauses show example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section (e.g., item 3).

14. A video processing method, comprising: performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures comprising one or more video slices and/or one or more video subpictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule that specifies that a flag indicating whether a single slice per subpicture mode is deemed to be enabled for a video picture in case that a picture partitioning is disabled for the video picture.

The following clauses show example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section (e.g., item 4).

15. A video processing method, comprising: performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures comprising one or more video slices and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule that specifies that a picture or a slice level chroma quantization parameter offset is signaled in a picture header or a slice header.

16. The method of clause 15, wherein the format rule specifies to include slice level chroma quantization parameter offsets in the slice header.

The following clauses show example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section (e.g., item 5).

17. A video processing method, comprising: performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures comprising one or more video slices and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule that specifies that a chroma quantization parameter (QP) table applicable for conversion of a video block of the video is derived as an XOR operation between (delta_qp_in_val_minus1[i][j]+1) and delta_qp_diff_val[i][j], wherein delta_qp_in_val_minus1[i][j] specifies a delta value used to derive the input coordinate of the j-th pivot point of the i-th chroma mapping table and delta_qp_diff_val[i][j] specifies a delta value used to derive the output coordinate of the j-th pivot point of the i-th chroma QP mapping table, where i and j are integers.

18. The method of any of clauses 1 to 17, wherein the conversion comprises encoding the video into the coded representation.

19. The method of any of clauses 1 to 17, wherein the conversion comprises decoding the coded representation to generate pixel values of the video.

20. A video decoding apparatus comprising a processor configured to implement a method recited in one or more of clauses 1 to 19.

21. A video encoding apparatus comprising a processor configured to implement a method recited in one or more of clauses 1 to 19.

22. A computer program product having computer code stored thereon, the code, when executed by a processor, causes the processor to implement a method recited in any of clauses 1 to 19.

23. A method, apparatus or system described in the present disclosure.

The second set of clauses shows example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section. The following clauses show example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section (e.g., item 31).

1. A video processing method (e.g., method 700 depicted in FIG. 7 ), comprising: performing (702) a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a first Syntax Element (SE) that indicates whether to signal Motion Vector Difference (MVD) for a reference picture list (RPL) is conditionally included in the coded representation based on whether a second SE indicating whether a reference picture list information is signaled in a picture header and a number of reference pictures in the RPL when the RPL information is present in picture header.

2. The method of clause 1, wherein the first SE is a flag indicative of whether motion vectors differences are disabled in the coded representation.

3. The method of any of clauses 1-2, wherein the second SE corresponds to a flag indicative of whether the RPL information is included in the picture header.

The following clauses show example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section (e.g., item 32).

4. A video processing method, comprising: performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a first Syntax Element (SE) that indicates whether to disable a decoder motion vector refinement (DMVR) tool is conditionally included in the coded representation based on whether a second SE indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in a Picture Header (PH), and a number of reference pictures in a previous RPL when the RPL information is present in PH, and/or whether a flag indicative of applicability of the DMVR tool included at a sequence parameter set level in the coded representation is equal to 1.

5. The method of clause 4, wherein the first SE corresponds to a flag indicative of whether the DMVR tool is disabled at the picture header level.

6. The method of any of clauses 4-5, wherein the second SE corresponds to a flag indicative of whether the RPL information is included at the picture header level.

The following clauses show example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section (e.g., item 33).

7. A video processing method, comprising: performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a first Syntax Element (SE) that indicates whether to disable a bi-directional optical flow (BDOF) tool is conditionally included in the coded representation based on whether a second SE indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in a Picture Header (PH), and a number of reference pictures in RPL-1 when the RPL information is present in PH, and/or a flag indicative of applicability of the BDOF tool at a sequence parameter set level.

8. The method of clause 7, wherein the first SE corresponds to a flag indicative of applicability of the BDOF tool at the picture header level.

9. The method of any of clauses 7-8, wherein the second SE corresponds to a flag indicative of whether the RPL information is included at the picture header level.

The following clauses show example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section (e.g., item 34).

10. A video processing method, comprising: performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a first Syntax Element (SE) that indicates whether the collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference picture list 0 is conditionally included based on a second SE indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in a Picture Header (PH), and a number of reference pictures in RPL-1 when the RPL information is present in PH, and whether a temporal motion vector prediction (TMVP) tool is enabled for coding a current picture.

11. The method of clause 10, wherein the first SE corresponds to a flag indicative of whether a collocated picture used for a temporal motion vector prediction is derived from a first reference picture list.

12. The method of any of clauses 10-11, wherein the second SE corresponds to a flag indicative of whether the RPL information is included at the picture header level.

The following clauses show example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section (e.g., items 35-38).

13. A video processing method, comprising: performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that whether a first syntax element (SE) indicating a table of prediction weights is included in the coded representation is conditionally based on a second SE indicating whether weighted prediction (WP) information is signalled in a picture header (PH), and whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in the PH, and a number of reference pictures in RPL-1 when the RPL information is present in the PH, and whether flags indicative of applicability of weighted prediction and/or weighted bi-prediction are included in a picture parameter set.

14. The method of clause 13, wherein the format rule further specifies that the first SE is signaled due to a condition being true.

15. A video processing method, comprising: performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more video pictures and a coded representation of the video, wherein the coded representation conforms to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that whether use of intra slices is allowed for representing a video picture in the coded representation depends on whether inter slices are allowed for the picture and whether there are more than one partitions.

16. The method of any of clauses 1-15, wherein the format rule further specifies that an adaptation parameter set is coded using a syntax element that is less than 5-bit wide.

17. The method of any of clauses 1-16, wherein the format rule specifies a coding or decoding order for general constraint flags syntax structure included in the coded representation such that flags in the general constraints flags syntax structure are groupwise included.

18. The method of any of clauses 1 to 17, wherein the conversion comprises encoding the video into the coded representation.

19. The method of any of clauses 1 to 17, wherein the conversion comprises decoding the coded representation to generate pixel values of the video.

20. A video decoding apparatus comprising a processor configured to implement a method recited in one or more of clauses 1 to 19.

21. A video encoding apparatus comprising a processor configured to implement a method recited in one or more of clauses 1 to 19.

22. A computer program product having computer code stored thereon, the code, when executed by a processor, causes the processor to implement a method recited in any of clauses 1 to 19.

23. A method, apparatus or system described in the present disclosure.

The third set of clauses shows example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section (e.g., items 30-34, 37 and 38).

1. A method of video processing (e.g., method 800 as shown in FIG. 8A), comprising: performing 802 a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates whether motion vector difference for a particular reference picture list (RPL) is indicated is conditionally included in the bitstream based on (i) whether a second syntax element indicating whether an RPL information is included in a picture header and/or (ii) a number of reference pictures in the particular RPL in case that the RPL information is present in the picture header.

2. The method of clause 1, wherein the first syntax element is a flag indicative of whether motion vector coding syntax structure of the particular RPL corresponding to reference picture list 1 is parsed or not parsed.

3. The method of clause 1 or 2, wherein the second syntax element corresponds to a flag indicative of whether the RPL information is included in the picture header.

4. The method of any of clauses 1 to 3, wherein the number of reference pictures in the particular RPL is set equal to a value of a variable indicating a number of entries in a RPL syntax structure for the particular RPL corresponding to reference picture list 1.

5. The method of any of clauses 1 to 4, wherein the format rule specifies whether to include the first syntax element depends on whether a condition, if(!pps_rpl_info_in_ph_flag∥num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0), is met, wherein pps_rpl_info_in_ph_flag is the second syntax element and num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1] is the number of reference pictures in the particular RPL for reference list 1.

6. The method of clause 5, wherein the first syntax element is ph_mvd_l1_zero_flag.

7. The method of clause 5, wherein the format rule specifies to include the first syntax element in case that the condition is met.

8. The method of clause 5, wherein the format rule specifies to omit the first syntax element in case that the condition is not met.

9. The method of any of clauses 1 to 4, wherein the format rule further specifies to infer a value of the first SE in case that the first syntax element is not included in the bitstream.

10. The method of clause 9, wherein the format rule further specifies to infer the value of the first syntax element to be equal to X, whereby X is an integer.

11. The method of clause 10, wherein X is 0, 1, or another syntax element.

12. The method of clause 10, wherein X is derived based on or conditioned by one or more another syntax elements.

13. A method of video processing (e.g., method 810 as shown in FIG. 8B), comprising: performing 812 a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a rule, and wherein the rule specifies which syntax elements in a general constraint information syntax structure that indicates one or more constraints applicable to the conversion are grouped together.

14. The method of clause 13, wherein the general constraint information syntax structure is general_constraints_info( ).

15. The method of clause 13, wherein the rule further specifies that general constraint syntax elements in a particular group are signalled together without interlacing with other general constraint syntax elements in another group.

16. The method of clause 13, wherein the rule specifies that inter-related syntax elements are grouped together, wherein the inter-related syntax elements include general constraint syntax elements about characteristics including at least one of reference picture resampling, resolution change in a coded layer video sequence, weighted prediction, reference wraparound, temporal motion vector prediction, subblock-based temporal motion vector prediction, adaptive motion vector prediction, bi-directional optical flow, symmetric motion vector difference, decoder-side motion vector derivation, merge based motion vector difference, affine motion prediction, prediction refinement with optical flow, bi-prediction with CU (coding unit) weights, combined inter-intra prediction CIIP, or geometric prediction mode.

17. The method of clause 13, wherein the rule specifies that intra-related syntax elements are grouped together, wherein the intra-related syntax elements include general constraint syntax elements about characteristics including at least one of a palette coding mode, intra block copy mode, intra sub-partitions (ISP), multi-reference line intra prediction, matrix-based intra prediction, or cross-component linear model.

18. The method of clause 13, wherein the rule specifies that syntax elements related to coding tools are grouped together.

19. The method of clause 13, wherein the rule specifies that syntax elements related to a functionality are grouped together, wherein the functionality-related syntax elements include at least one of general constraint syntax elements about intra only, all layers independent, or one access unit only.

20. The method of clause 13, wherein the rule specifies that network abstraction layer (NAL) unit type related syntax elements are grouped together, wherein the NAL unit type related syntax elements include at least one of general constraint syntax elements about a NAL unit type equal to TRAIL, STSA, RASL, RADL, IDR, CRA, GDR, APS, or other types.

21. The method of clause 13, wherein the rule specifies that partitioning-related syntax elements are grouped together, wherein the partitioning-related syntax elements are about partitioning of a tile, slice, or subpicture.

22. The method of clause 13, wherein the rule specifies that partitioning related syntax elements are grouped together, wherein the partitioning-related syntax elements are about partitioning of a coding tree unit or a block.

23. The method of clause 13, wherein the rule specifies that transform, quantization, residual coding related syntax elements are grouped together, wherein the transform, quantization, residual coding related syntax elements include general constraint syntax elements about characteristics including at least one of transform skip, sub-block transform, multiple transform selection, low frequency non-separable secondary transform, explicit scaling list, dependent quantization, CU (coding unit) QP (quantization parameter) delta, chroma QP offset, joint CbCr, adaptive colour transform, or sign data hiding.

24. The method of clause 13, wherein the rule specifies that loop filter related syntax elements are grouped together, wherein the loop filter related syntax elements include general constraint syntax elements about characteristics including at least one of adaptive loop filtering, cross-component adaptive loop filtering, sample adaptive offset, luma mapping with chroma scaling, or large-block adaptive deblocking filter.

25. A method of video processing (e.g., method 820 as shown in FIG. 8C), comprising: performing 822 a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that an indication that use of intra slices within a picture is enabled for a picture is selectively included based on (i) whether an inter slice is allowed in the picture and/or (ii) whether the picture is partitioned into more than one partitions.

26. The method of clause 25, wherein the format rule specifies to include the indication in case a condition, ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag is met, wherein ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag indicates whether the inter slice is allowed.

27. The method of clause 25, wherein the format rule specifies that in response to a value of a first syntax element specifies a presence of one or more coded slices in the picture that has a slice type equal to B or P slice, a second syntax element indicates whether the inter slice is allowed is included in the bitstream.

28. The method of clause 25, wherein the format rule specifies to include the indication in case a condition, ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag && (!no_pic_partition_flag && !(rect_slice_flag && num_slices_in_pic_minus1==0, is met, wherein ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag indicates whether the inter slice is allowed and no_pic_partition_flag indicates whether the picture is partitioned into more than one tile or slice, rect_slice_flag indicates whether a rectangular slice mode is in use for the picture, and num_slices_in_pic_minus1 indicates a number of rectangular slices in the picture.

29. The method of clause 28, wherein the format rule specifies to omit the indication in case that the condition is not met.

30. The method of clause 29, wherein the format rule specifies to infer a value of the indication in case that the indication is not present.

31. The method of clause 30, wherein the format rule specifies to infer the value of the indication to be equal to (!ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag) or (1−ph_inter_slice_allowed_flag).

32. A method of video processing (e.g., method 830 as shown in FIG. 8D), comprising: performing 832 a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates whether a decoder motion vector refinement (DMVR) tool is disabled is conditionally included in the bitstream based on (i) whether a second syntax element indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is included in a picture header (PH), and/or (ii) a number of reference pictures in a RPL in case that the RPL information is present in the PH, and/or (iii) whether a flag indicative of applicability of the DMVR tool included at a sequence parameter set level in the bitstream is equal to a certain value.

33. The method of clause 32, wherein the first syntax element corresponds to a PH flag indicative of whether the DMVR tool is disabled.

34. The method of clause 32 or 33, wherein the second syntax element corresponds to a flag indicative of whether the RPL information is included in the picture header.

35. The method of any of clauses 32 to 34, wherein the number of reference pictures in the RPL is set equal to a value of a syntax element indicating a number of entries in a RPL syntax structure.

36. The method of any of clauses 32 to 35, wherein the format rule specifies whether to include the first syntax element depends on whether a condition, if(sps_dmvr_pic_present_flag && (!rpl_info_in_ph_flag (num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0))), is met, wherein rpl_info_in_ph_flag is the second syntax element, num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1] is the number of reference pictures in the RPL, and sps_dmvr_pic_present_flag is the flag indicative of the applicability of the DMVR tool.

37. The method of clause 36, wherein the format rule specifies to include the first syntax element in case that the condition is met.

38. The method of clause 36, wherein the format rule specifies to omit the first syntax element in case that the condition is not met.

39. The method of any of clauses 32 to 35, wherein the format rule further specifies to infer a value of the first syntax element in case that the first syntax element is not included in the bitstream.

40. The method of clause 39, wherein the format rule further specifies to infer the value of the first syntax element to be equal to X, whereby X is an integer.

41. The method of clause 40, wherein X is 0, 1, or another syntax element.

42. The method of clause 40, wherein X is derived based on or conditioned by one or more another syntax elements.

43. A method of video processing (e.g., method 840 as shown in FIG. 8E), comprising: performing 842 a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates whether to disable a bi-directional optical flow (BDOF) tool is conditionally included in the bitstream based on (i) whether a second syntax element indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is included in a picture header (PH), and/or (ii) a number of reference pictures in a RPL in case that the RPL information is present in the PH, and/or (iii) a flag indicative of applicability of the BDOF tool at a sequence parameter set level.

44. The method of clause 43, wherein the first syntax element corresponds to a PH flag indicative of applicability of the BDOF tool.

45. The method of clause 43 or 44, wherein the second syntax element corresponds to a flag indicative of whether the RPL information is included in the picture header.

46. The method of any of clauses 43 to 45, wherein the number of reference pictures in the RPL is set equal to a value of a syntax element indicating a number of entries in a RPL syntax structure.

47. The method of any of clauses 43 to 46, wherein the format rule specifies whether to include the first syntax element depends on whether a condition, if(sps_bdof_pic_present_flag && (!rpl_info_in_ph_flag (num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0))), is met, wherein rpl_info_in_ph_flag is the second syntax element, num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1] is the number of reference pictures in the RPL, and sps_bdof_pic_present_flag is the flag indicative of the applicability of the BDOF tool.

48. The method of clause 47, wherein the format rule specifies to include the first syntax element in case that the condition is met.

49. The method of clause 47, wherein the format rule specifies to omit the first syntax element in case that the condition is not met.

50. The method of any of clauses 43 to 46, wherein the format rule further specifies to infer a value of the first syntax element in case that the first syntax element is not included in the bitstream.

51. The method of clause 50, wherein the format rule further specifies to infer the value of the first syntax element to be equal to X, whereby X is an integer.

52. The method of clause 51, wherein X is 0, 1, or another syntax element.

53. The method of clause 51, wherein X is derived based on or conditioned by one or more another syntax elements.

54. A method of video processing (e.g., method 850 as shown in FIG. 8F), comprising: performing 852 a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates whether a collocated picture used for temporal motion vector prediction is derived from reference picture list 0 is conditionally included based on (i) a second syntax element indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is signaled in a picture header (PH), and/or (ii) a number of reference pictures in a RPL in case that the RPL information is present in the PH, and/or (iii) a flag indicative of an applicability of a temporal motion vector prediction (TMVP) tool for coding a current picture.

55. The method of clause 54, wherein the first syntax element corresponds to a flag indicative of whether the collocated picture used for the temporal motion vector prediction is derived from the reference picture list 0 or a reference picture list 1.

56. The method of clause 53 or 54, wherein the second syntax element corresponds to a flag indicative of whether the RPL information is included in the picture header.

57. The method of any of clauses 54 to 56, wherein the number of reference pictures in the RPL is set equal to a value of a syntax element indicating a number of entries in a RPL syntax structure.

58. The method of any of clauses 54 to 57, wherein the format rule specifies whether to include the first syntax element depends on whether a condition, if(ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag&&(!rpl_info_in_ph_flag| num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0), is met, wherein rpl_info_in_ph_flag is the second syntax element, num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1] is the number of reference pictures in the RPL, and ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag is the flag indicative of the applicability of the temporal motion vector prediction (TMVP) tool.

59. The method of any of clauses 54 to 57, wherein the format rule specifies whether to include the first syntax element depends on whether a condition,

-   -   if(ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag&&rpl_info_in_ph_flag&&num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0),         is met, wherein rpl_info_in_ph_flag is the second syntax         element, num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1] is the number of         reference pictures in the RPL, and ph_temporal_mvp_enabled_flag         is the flag indicative of the applicability of the temporal         motion vector prediction (TMVP) tool.

60. The method of clause 58 or 59, wherein the format rule specifies to include the first syntax element in case that the condition is met.

61. The method of clause 58 or 59, wherein the format rule specifies to omit the first syntax element in case that the condition is not met.

62. The method of any of clauses 54 to 57, wherein the format rule further specifies to infer a value of the first syntax element in case that the first syntax element is not included in the bitstream.

63. The method of clause 62, wherein the format rule further specifies to infer the value of the first syntax element to be equal to X, whereby X is an integer.

64. The method of clause 63, wherein X is 0, 1, or another syntax element.

65. The method of clause 63, wherein X is derived based on or conditioned by one or more another syntax elements.

66. A method of video processing (e.g., method 860 as shown in FIG. 8G), comprising: performing 862 a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies whether a first syntax element indicating a table of prediction weights is conditionally included in the bitstream based on (i) a second syntax element indicating whether weighted prediction (WP) information is included in a picture header (PH), and/or (ii) a third syntax element indicating whether a reference picture list (RPL) information is included in the PH, and/or (iii) a number of reference pictures in a RPL in case that the RPL information is present in the PH, and/or (iv) a fourth syntax element indicating an applicability of weighted prediction and/or a fifth syntax element indicating an applicability of weighted bi-prediction that is included in a picture parameter set.

67. The method of clause 66, wherein the format rule specifies whether to include the first syntax element depends on whether a condition, if((pps_weighted_pred_flag∥(pps_weighted_bipred_flag && (!rpl_info_in_ph_flag num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0))) && wp_info_in_ph_flag), is met, and wherein wp_info_in_ph_flag is the second syntax element, rpl_info_in_ph_flag is the third syntax element, num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1] is the number of reference pictures in the RPL, pps_weighted_pred_flag is the fourth syntax element, and pps_weighted_bipred_flag is the fifth syntax element.

68. The method of clause 67, wherein the format rule specifies to include the first syntax element in the picture header in case the condition is met.

69. The method of clause 67, wherein the format rule specifies to omit the first syntax element in case that the condition is not met.

70. The method of any of clauses 1 to 69, wherein the conversion includes encoding the video into the bitstream.

71. The method of any of clauses 1 to 69, wherein the conversion includes decoding the video from the bitstream.

72. The method of any of clauses 1 to 69, wherein the conversion includes generating the bitstream from the video, and the method further comprises: storing the bitstream in a non-transitory computer-readable recording medium.

73. A video processing apparatus comprising a processor configured to implement a method recited in any one or more of clauses 1 to 72.

74. A method of storing a bitstream of a video, comprising, a method recited in any one of clauses 1 to 72, and further including storing the bitstream to a non-transitory computer-readable recording medium.

75. A computer readable medium storing program code that, when executed, causes a processor to implement a method recited in any one or more of clauses 1 to 72.

76. A computer readable medium that stores a bitstream generated according to any of the above described methods.

77. A video processing apparatus for storing a bitstream, wherein the video processing apparatus is configured to implement a method recited in any one or more of clauses 1 to 72.

The fourth set of clauses shows example embodiments of techniques discussed in the previous section (e.g., item 35).

1. A method of video processing (e.g., method 900 as shown in FIG. 9 ), comprising: performing 902 a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates a number of weights signalled for entries in a particular reference picture list is conditionally included in a syntax structure indicating a table of prediction weight parameters of the bitstream based on (i) a second syntax element indicating whether weighted prediction (WP) information is included in a picture header and/or (ii) a third syntax element indicating whether reference picture list (RPL) information is included in the picture header, and/or (iii) a number of reference pictures in the particular RPL, and/or (iv) a fourth syntax element included in a picture parameter set and indicating an applicability of explicit weighted prediction to B slices referring to the picture parameter set.

2. The method of clause 1, wherein the particular reference picture list is a reference picture list 1.

3. The method of clause 1 or 2, wherein the format rule specifies whether the first syntax element is included in the syntax structure indicating the table of prediction weight parameters is based on a value of the second syntax element, a value of the fourth syntax element and the number of reference pictures in the particular RPL.

4. The method of clause 1 or 2, wherein the format rule specifies that the first syntax element is included in the syntax structure upon satisfying (1) the second syntax element having a first value, (2) the fourth syntax element having a second value, and (3) the number of reference pictures in the particular RPL being greater than 0.

5. The method of clause 4, wherein the first value of the second syntax element specifies a possible presence of the WP information in the picture header and a non-presence of the WP information in slice headers referring to the picture parameter set that do not contain a picture header.

6. The method of clause 4, wherein the second value of the second syntax element specifies that the explicit weighted prediction is applied to B slices referring to the picture parameter set.

7. The method of clause 1 or 2, wherein the format rule specifies to exclude the first syntax element from the syntax structure upon satisfying upon satisfying one of (1) a value of the second syntax element being equal to 0, (2) a value of the fourth syntax element being equal to 0, or (3) the number of reference pictures in the particular RPL being equal to 0.

8. The method of clause 1, wherein the first syntax element corresponds to a flag indicative of the number of weights signalled for entries in the particular RPL corresponding to a reference picture list 1.

9. The method of clause 1 or 2, wherein the format rule specifies whether to include the first syntax element depends on whether a condition, if((pps_weighted_bipred_flag && (!rpl_info_in_ph_flag num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0)) && wp_info_in_ph_flag), is met, wherein pps_weighted_bipred_flag is the fourth flag, rpl_info_in_ph_flag is the third syntax element, num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1] is the number of reference pictures in the RPL, and wp_info_in_ph_flag is the second syntax element.

10. The method of clause 1 or 2, wherein the format rule specifies whether to include the first syntax element depends on whether a condition, if(pps_weighted_bipred_flag && num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]>0 && wp_info_in_ph_flag), is met, wherein pps_weighted_bipred_flag is the fourth flag, num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1] is the number of reference pictures in the particular RPL, and wp_info_in_ph_flag is the second syntax element.

11. The method of clause 9 or 10, wherein the format rule specifies to include the first syntax element in the syntax structure in case that the condition is met.

12. The method of clause 9 or 10, wherein the format rule specifies to include the first syntax element in the picture header in case that the condition is met.

13. The method of clause 9 or 10, wherein the format rule specifies to exclude the first syntax element from the syntax structure indicating the table of prediction weights parameters in case that the condition is not met.

14. The method of clause 13, wherein the format rule further specifies to infer a value of the first syntax element in case that the first syntax element is not included in the bitstream.

15. The method of clause 9 or 10, wherein the format rule further specifies that in case that the condition is not met, the first syntax element is exclude from the syntax structure and a value of the first syntax element is not inferred.

16. The method of clause 15, wherein, in response to the condition being not met, a value of variable corresponding to weights for the particular RPL is derived.

17. The method of clause 16, wherein the format rule further specifies to derive the value of the variable to be equal to 0 upon satisfying a first condition, if(!pps_weighted_bipred_flag∥(wp_info_in_ph_flag && num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]==0)), wherein pps_weighted_bipred_flag is the fourth syntax element, num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1] is the number of reference pictures in the particular RPL, and wp_info_in_ph_flag is the second syntax element.

18. The method of clause 17, wherein the format rule further specifies to derive the value of the variable to be equal to a value of the first syntax element upon not satisfying the first condition and satisfying a second condition, the value of the second syntax element indicating that the WP information is included in the picture header.

19. The method of clause 18, wherein the format rule further specifies to derive the value of the variable to be equal to a number of active reference indices to be used for a current slice upon not satisfying the first condition and the second condition.

20. The method of clause 9 or 10, wherein the format rule further specifies that in case that the condition is not met, the first syntax element is omitted, a value of the first syntax element is not inferred, and a value of a variable corresponding to weight for the particular RPL is derived based on the second syntax element and/or the third syntax element and/or the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL.

21. The method of clause 20, wherein the format rule further specifies to derive the value of the variable to be equal to 0 upon satisfying a first condition, if(!pps_weighted_bipred_flag).

22. The method of clause 21, wherein the format rule further specifies to derive the value of the variable to be equal to 0 upon not satisfying the first condition and satisfying a second condition, if (wp_info_in_ph_flag && rpl_info_in_ph_flag && num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]]==0).

23. The method of clause 22, wherein the format rule further specifies to derive the value of the variable to be equal to a number of weights signalled for entries in the particular RPL upon not satisfying the first condition and the second condition and satisfying a third condition, if(wp_info_in_ph_flag).

24. The method of clause 23, wherein the format rule further specifies to derive the value of the variable to be equal to a number of active reference indices to be used for a current slice upon not satisfying the first condition, the second condition, and the third condition.

25. The method of any of clauses 1 to 24, wherein the conversion includes encoding the video into the bitstream.

26. The method of any of clauses 1 to 24, wherein the conversion includes decoding the video from the bitstream.

27. The method of clauses 1 to 24, wherein the conversion includes generating the bitstream from the video, and the method further comprises: storing the bitstream in a non-transitory computer-readable recording medium.

28. A video processing apparatus comprising a processor configured to implement a method recited in any one or more of clauses 1 to 27.

29. A method of storing a bitstream of a video, comprising, a method recited in any one of clauses 1 to 27, and further including storing the bitstream to a non-transitory computer-readable recording medium.

30. A computer readable medium storing program code that, when executed, causes a processor to implement a method recited in any one or more of clauses 1 to 27.

31. A computer readable medium that stores a bitstream generated according to any of the above described methods.

32. A video processing apparatus for storing a bitstream representation, wherein the video processing apparatus is configured to implement a method recited in any one or more of clauses 1 to 27.

In the present disclosure, the term “video processing” may refer to video encoding, video decoding, video compression or video decompression. For example, video compression algorithms may be applied during conversion from pixel representation of a video to a corresponding bitstream representation or vice versa. The bitstream representation of a current video block may, for example, correspond to bits that are either co-located or spread in different places within the bitstream, as is defined by the syntax. For example, a macroblock may be encoded in terms of transformed and coded error residual values and also using bits in headers and other fields in the bitstream. Furthermore, during conversion, a decoder may parse a bitstream with the knowledge that some fields may be present, or absent, based on the determination, as is described in the above solutions. Similarly, an encoder may determine that certain syntax fields are or are not to be included and generate the coded representation accordingly by including or excluding the syntax fields from the coded representation.

The disclosed and other solutions, examples, embodiments, modules and the functional operations described in this document can be implemented in digital electronic circuitry, or in computer software, firmware, or hardware, including the structures disclosed in this document and their structural equivalents, or in combinations of one or more of them. The disclosed and other embodiments can be implemented as one or more computer program products, i.e., one or more modules of computer program instructions encoded on a computer readable medium for execution by, or to control the operation of, data processing apparatus. The computer readable medium can be a machine-readable storage device, a machine-readable storage substrate, a memory device, a composition of matter effecting a machine-readable propagated signal, or a combination of one or more them. The term “data processing apparatus” encompasses all apparatus, devices, and machines for processing data, including by way of example a programmable processor, a computer, or multiple processors or computers. The apparatus can include, in addition to hardware, code that creates an execution environment for the computer program in question, e.g., code that constitutes processor firmware, a protocol stack, a database management system, an operating system, or a combination of one or more of them. A propagated signal is an artificially generated signal, e.g., a machine-generated electrical, optical, or electromagnetic signal, that is generated to encode information for transmission to suitable receiver apparatus.

A computer program (also known as a program, software, software application, script, or code) can be written in any form of programming language, including compiled or interpreted languages, and it can be deployed in any form, including as a stand-alone program or as a module, component, subroutine, or other unit suitable for use in a computing environment. A computer program does not necessarily correspond to a file in a file system. A program can be stored in a portion of a file that holds other programs or data (e.g., one or more scripts stored in a markup language document), in a single file dedicated to the program in question, or in multiple coordinated files (e.g., files that store one or more modules, sub programs, or portions of code). A computer program can be deployed to be executed on one computer or on multiple computers that are located at one site or distributed across multiple sites and interconnected by a communication network.

The processes and logic flows described in this document can be performed by one or more programmable processors executing one or more computer programs to perform functions by operating on input data and generating output. The processes and logic flows can also be performed by, and apparatus can also be implemented as, special purpose logic circuitry, e.g., an FPGA (field programmable gate array) or an ASIC (application specific integrated circuit).

Processors suitable for the execution of a computer program include, by way of example, both general and special purpose microprocessors, and any one or more processors of any kind of digital computer. Generally, a processor will receive instructions and data from a read only memory or a random-access memory or both. The essential elements of a computer are a processor for performing instructions and one or more memory devices for storing instructions and data. Generally, a computer will also include, or be operatively coupled to receive data from or transfer data to, or both, one or more mass storage devices for storing data, e.g., magnetic, magneto optical disks, or optical disks. However, a computer need not have such devices. Computer readable media suitable for storing computer program instructions and data include all forms of non-volatile memory, media and memory devices, including by way of example semiconductor memory devices, e.g., erasable programmable read-only memory (EPROM), electrically erasable programmable read-only memory (EEPROM), and flash memory devices; magnetic disks, e.g., internal hard disks or removable disks; magneto optical disks; and compact disc, read-only memory (CD ROM) and digital versatile disc read-only memory (DVD-ROM) disks. The processor and the memory can be supplemented by, or incorporated in, special purpose logic circuitry.

While the present disclosure contains many specifics, these should not be construed as limitations on the scope of any subject matter or of what may be claimed, but rather as descriptions of features that may be specific to particular embodiments of particular techniques. Certain features that are described in the present disclosure in the context of separate embodiments can also be implemented in combination in a single embodiment. Conversely, various features that are described in the context of a single embodiment can also be implemented in multiple embodiments separately or in any suitable subcombination. Moreover, although features may be described above as acting in certain combinations and even initially claimed as such, one or more features from a claimed combination can in some cases be excised from the combination, and the claimed combination may be directed to a subcombination or variation of a subcombination.

Similarly, while operations are depicted in the drawings in a particular order, this should not be understood as requiring that such operations be performed in the particular order shown or in sequential order, or that all illustrated operations be performed, to achieve desirable results. Moreover, the separation of various system components in the embodiments described in the present disclosure should not be understood as requiring such separation in all embodiments.

Only a few implementations and examples are described and other implementations, enhancements and variations can be made based on what is described and illustrated in the present disclosure. 

What is claimed is:
 1. A method of processing video data, comprising: performing a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates a number of weights signaled for entries in a particular reference picture list (RPL) is conditionally included in a weighted prediction parameters syntax structure indicating a table of weighted prediction parameters of the bitstream based on (iii) a second syntax element included in a picture parameter set indicating an applicability of explicit weighted prediction (WP) to B slices referring to picture parameter set information, and (iv) a third syntax element indicating whether WP information is included in a picture header, and (iii) a fourth syntax element indicating a number of reference pictures in the particular RPL.
 2. The method of claim 1, wherein the particular RPL corresponds to reference picture list
 1. 3. The method of claim 1, wherein the format rule further specifies that a fifth syntax element that indicates whether motion vector difference coding syntax structure for the particular RPL is parsed or not parsed is included in the bitstream when (i) a value of a sixth syntax element indicates that an RPL information is not present in the picture header or (ii) a value of the fourth syntax element indicates the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL is greater than 0 in case that the RPL information is present in the picture header, and the fifth syntax element is excluded from the bitstream when the value of the sixth syntax element indicates that the RPL information is present in the picture header and the value of the fourth syntax element indicates the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL is equal to
 0. 4. The method of claim 3, wherein the format rule further specifies that a value of the fifth syntax element is inferred to be equal to 1 in case that the fifth syntax element is not included in the bitstream, wherein the value of the fifth syntax element equal to 1 specifies that the motion vector difference coding syntax structure for the particular RPL is not parsed.
 5. The method of claim 1, wherein the format rule specifies that the first syntax element is included in the weighted prediction parameters syntax structure upon satisfying (1) the second syntax element having a first value which specifies that the explicit WP is applied to B slices referring to the picture parameter set, wherein the first value is equal to 1, (2) the third syntax element having a second value which specifies that a possible presence of the WP information in the picture header and a non-presence of the WP information in slice headers referring to the picture parameter set that do not contain the picture header, wherein the second value is equal to 1, and (3) the value of the fourth syntax element indicating the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL being greater than
 0. 6. The method of claim 1, wherein the format rule specifies that the first syntax element is excluded from the weighted prediction parameters syntax structure upon not satisfying at least one of (1) the second syntax element having a first value which specifies that the explicit WP is applied to B slices referring to the picture parameter set, (2) the third syntax element having a second value which specifies that a possible presence of the WP information in the picture header and a non-presence of the WP information in slice headers referring to the picture parameter set that do not contain the picture header, and (3) the value of the fourth syntax element indicating the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL being greater than
 0. 7. The method of claim 1, wherein the format rule specifies that a value of a first variable NumWeightsL1 corresponding to weights for the particular RPL is derived as follows:  if( !pps_weighted_bipred_flag | | ( pps_wp_info_in_ph_flag && num_ref_entries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx[ l ] ] = = 0 ) )   NumWeightsL1 = 0  else if( pps_wp_info_in_ph_flag )   NumWeightsL1 = num_l1_weights  else    NumWeightsL1 = NumRefIdxActive[ 1 ],

wherein pps_weighted_bipred_flag is the second syntax element, pps_wp_info_in_ph_flag is the third syntax element, num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is the fourth syntax element, num_l1_weights is the first syntax element, and NumRefIdxActive[1] is a second variable indicating a number of active reference pictures in reference picture list 1 that are allowed to be used to code at least one slice.
 8. The method of claim 1, wherein the format rule specifies which general constraint syntax elements in a general constraint information syntax structure that indicates one or more constraints applicable to the conversion are grouped together, and wherein the general constraint syntax elements in a particular group are signaled together without interlacing with other general constraint syntax elements in another group.
 9. The method of claim 8, wherein the format rule specifies that inter-related syntax elements are grouped together, wherein the inter-related syntax elements include the general constraint syntax elements about characteristics including at least one of reference picture resampling, resolution change in a coded layer video sequence, weighted prediction, reference wraparound, temporal motion vector prediction, subblock-based temporal motion vector prediction, adaptive motion vector prediction, bi-directional optical flow, symmetric motion vector difference, decoder-side motion vector derivation, merge based motion vector difference, affine motion prediction, prediction refinement with optical flow, bi-prediction with CU (coding unit) weights, combined inter-intra prediction CIIP, or geometric prediction mode.
 10. The method of claim 8, wherein the format rule specifies that intra-related syntax elements are grouped together, wherein the intra-related syntax elements include the general constraint syntax elements about characteristics including at least one of a palette coding mode, intra block copy mode, intra sub-partitions (ISP), multi-reference line intra prediction, matrix-based intra prediction, or cross-component linear model.
 11. The method of claim 1, wherein the conversion includes encoding the video into the bitstream.
 12. The method of claim 1, wherein the conversion includes decoding the video from the bitstream.
 13. An apparatus for processing video data comprising a processor and a non-transitory memory with instructions thereon, wherein the instructions upon execution by the processor, cause the processor to: perform a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, and wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates a number of weights signaled for entries in a particular reference picture list (RPL) is conditionally included in a weighted prediction parameters syntax structure indicating a table of weighted prediction parameters of the bitstream based on (iii) a second syntax element included in a picture parameter set indicating an applicability of explicit weighted prediction (WP) to B slices referring to picture parameter set information, and (iv) a third syntax element indicating whether WP information is included in a picture header, and (iii) a fourth syntax element indicating a number of reference pictures in the particular RPL.
 14. The apparatus of claim 13, wherein the particular RPL corresponds to reference picture list 1, and wherein the format rule further specifies that a fifth syntax element that indicates whether motion vector difference coding syntax structure for the particular RPL is parsed or not parsed is included in the bitstream when (i) a value of a sixth syntax element indicates that an RPL information is not present in the picture header or (ii) a value of the fourth syntax element indicates the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL is greater than 0 in case that the RPL information is present in the picture header, and the fifth syntax element is excluded from the bitstream when the value of the sixth syntax element indicates that the RPL information is present in the picture header and the value of the fourth syntax element indicates the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL is equal to
 0. 15. The apparatus of claim 14, wherein the format rule further specifies that a value of the fifth syntax element is inferred to be equal to 1 in case that the fifth syntax element is not included in the bitstream, wherein the value of the fifth syntax element equal to 1 specifies that the motion vector difference coding syntax structure for the particular RPL is not parsed.
 16. The apparatus of claim 13, wherein the format rule specifies that the first syntax element is included in the weighted prediction parameters syntax structure upon satisfying (1) the second syntax element having a first value which specifies that the explicit WP is applied to B slices referring to the picture parameter set, wherein the first value is equal to 1, (2) the third syntax element having a second value which specifies that a possible presence of the WP information in the picture header and a non-presence of the WP information in slice headers referring to the picture parameter set that do not contain the picture header, wherein the second value is equal to 1, and (3) the value of the fourth syntax element indicating the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL being greater than 0, wherein the format rule specifies that the first syntax element is excluded from the weighted prediction parameters syntax structure upon not satisfying at least one of (1) the second syntax element having a first value which specifies that the explicit WP is applied to B slices referring to the picture parameter set, (2) the third syntax element having a second value which specifies that a possible presence of the WP information in the picture header and a non-presence of the WP information in slice headers referring to the picture parameter set that do not contain the picture header, and (3) the value of the fourth syntax element indicating the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL being greater than 0, and wherein the format rule specifies that a value of a first variable NumWeightsL1 corresponding to weights for the particular RPL is derived as follows:  if( !pps_weighted_bipred_flag | | ( pps_wp_info_in_ph_flag && num_ref_entries[ 1 ][ RplsIdx[ 1 ] ] = = 0 ) )  NumWeightsL1 = 0  else if( pps_wp_info_in_ph_flag )  NumWeightsL1 = num_l1_weights  else  NumWeightsL1 = NumRefIdxActive[ 1 ],

wherein pps_weighted_bipred_flag is the second syntax element, pps_wp_info_in_ph_flag is the third syntax element, num_ref_entries[1][RplsIdx[1]] is the fourth syntax element, num_l1_weights is the first syntax element, and NumRefIdxActive[1] is a second variable indicating a number of active reference pictures in reference picture list 1 that are allowed to be used to code at least one slice.
 17. A non-transitory computer-readable storage medium storing instructions that cause a processor to: perform a conversion between a video comprising one or more pictures and a bitstream of the video according to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates a number of weights signaled for entries in a particular reference picture list (RPL) is conditionally included in a weighted prediction parameters syntax structure indicating a table of weighted prediction parameters of the bitstream based on (iii) a second syntax element included in a picture parameter set indicating an applicability of explicit weighted prediction (WP) to B slices referring to picture parameter set information, and (iv) a third syntax element indicating whether WP information is included in a picture header, and (iii) a fourth syntax element indicating a number of reference pictures in the particular RPL.
 18. The non-transitory computer-readable storage medium of claim 17, wherein the particular RPL corresponds to reference picture list 1, wherein the format rule further specifies that a fifth syntax element that indicates whether motion vector difference coding syntax structure for the particular RPL is parsed or not parsed is included in the bitstream when (i) a value of a sixth syntax element indicates that an RPL information is not present in the picture header or (ii) a value of the fourth syntax element indicates the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL is greater than 0 in case that the RPL information is present in the picture header, and the fifth syntax element is excluded from the bitstream when the value of the sixth syntax element indicates that the RPL information is present in the picture header and the value of the fourth syntax element indicates the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL is equal to 0, and wherein the format rule further specifies that a value of the fifth syntax element is inferred to be equal to 1 in case that the fifth syntax element is not included in the bitstream, wherein the value of the fifth syntax element equal to 1 specifies that the motion vector difference coding syntax structure for the particular RPL is not parsed.
 19. A non-transitory computer-readable recording medium storing a bitstream of a video which is generated by a method performed by a video processing apparatus, wherein the method comprises: generating the bitstream of the video comprising one or more pictures according to a format rule, wherein the format rule specifies that a first syntax element that indicates a number of weights signaled for entries in a particular reference picture list (RPL) is conditionally included in a weighted prediction parameters syntax structure indicating a table of weighted prediction parameters of the bitstream based on (iii) a second syntax element included in a picture parameter set indicating an applicability of explicit weighted prediction (WP) to B slices referring to picture parameter set information, and (iv) a third syntax element indicating whether WP information is included in a picture header, and (iii) a fourth syntax element indicating a number of reference pictures in the particular RPL.
 20. The non-transitory computer-readable recording medium of claim 19, wherein the particular RPL corresponds to reference picture list 1, wherein the format rule further specifies that a fifth syntax element that indicates whether motion vector difference coding syntax structure for the particular RPL is parsed or not parsed is included in the bitstream when (i) a value of a sixth syntax element indicates that an RPL information is not present in the picture header or (ii) a value of the fourth syntax element indicates the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL is greater than 0 in case that the RPL information is present in the picture header, and the fifth syntax element is excluded from the bitstream when the value of the sixth syntax element indicates that the RPL information is present in the picture header and the value of the fourth syntax element indicates the number of the reference pictures in the particular RPL is equal to 0, and wherein the format rule further specifies that a value of the fifth syntax element is inferred to be equal to 1 in case that the fifth syntax element is not included in the bitstream, wherein the value of the fifth syntax element equal to 1 specifies that the motion vector difference coding syntax structure for the particular RPL is not parsed. 